1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 /*
3 * mac80211 <-> driver interface
4 *
5 * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
6 * Copyright 2006-2007 Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
7 * Copyright 2007-2010 Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8 * Copyright 2013-2014 Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9 * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10 * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2019 Intel Corporation
11 */
12
13 #ifndef MAC80211_H
14 #define MAC80211_H
15
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/kernel.h>
18 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
19 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
21 #include <net/cfg80211.h>
22 #include <net/codel.h>
23 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
24 #include <asm/unaligned.h>
25
26 /**
27 * DOC: Introduction
28 *
29 * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
30 * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
31 * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
32 * drivers.
33 */
34
35 /**
36 * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
37 *
38 * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
39 * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
40 * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
41 * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
42 * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
43 * tasklet function.
44 *
45 * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
46 * use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
47 */
48
49 /**
50 * DOC: Warning
51 *
52 * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
53 * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
54 */
55
56 /**
57 * DOC: Frame format
58 *
59 * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
60 * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
61 * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
62 * hardware.
63 *
64 * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
65 *
66 * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
67 * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
68 *
69 * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
70 * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
71 */
72
73 /**
74 * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
75 *
76 * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
77 * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
78 * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
79 * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
80 *
81 * mac80211 will flushed the workqueue upon interface removal and during
82 * suspend.
83 *
84 * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
85 *
86 */
87
88 /**
89 * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
90 *
91 * mac80211 provides an optional intermediate queueing implementation designed
92 * to allow the driver to keep hardware queues short and provide some fairness
93 * between different stations/interfaces.
94 * In this model, the driver pulls data frames from the mac80211 queue instead
95 * of letting mac80211 push them via drv_tx().
96 * Other frames (e.g. control or management) are still pushed using drv_tx().
97 *
98 * Drivers indicate that they use this model by implementing the .wake_tx_queue
99 * driver operation.
100 *
101 * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
102 * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
103 * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
104 *
105 * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
106 * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
107 *
108 * The driver can't access the queue directly. To dequeue a frame from a
109 * txq, it calls ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a
110 * queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue driver op.
111 *
112 * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
113 * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
114 * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
115 * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
116 * ieee80211_return_txq().
117 *
118 * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
119 * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
120 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
121 * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
122 * .release_buffered_frames().
123 * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
124 * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
125 * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
126 */
127
128 struct device;
129
130 /**
131 * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
132 *
133 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
134 * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
135 */
136 enum ieee80211_max_queues {
137 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES = 16,
138 IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP = BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
139 };
140
141 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE 0xff
142
143 /**
144 * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
145 * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
146 * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
147 * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
148 * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
149 */
150 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
151 IEEE80211_AC_VO = 0,
152 IEEE80211_AC_VI = 1,
153 IEEE80211_AC_BE = 2,
154 IEEE80211_AC_BK = 3,
155 };
156
157 /**
158 * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
159 *
160 * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
161 * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
162 *
163 * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
164 * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
165 * 2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
166 * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
167 * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
168 * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
169 * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
170 * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
171 * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
172 */
173 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
174 u16 txop;
175 u16 cw_min;
176 u16 cw_max;
177 u8 aifs;
178 bool acm;
179 bool uapsd;
180 bool mu_edca;
181 struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
182 };
183
184 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
185 unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
186 unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
187 unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
188 unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
189 };
190
191 /**
192 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
193 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
194 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
195 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
196 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
197 * this is used only with channel switching with CSA
198 * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed
199 */
200 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
201 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH = BIT(0),
202 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS = BIT(1),
203 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR = BIT(2),
204 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(3),
205 IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH = BIT(4),
206 };
207
208 /**
209 * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
210 *
211 * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
212 * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
213 *
214 * @def: the channel definition
215 * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
216 * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
217 * active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
218 * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
219 * after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
220 * this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
221 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
222 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
223 * sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
224 */
225 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
226 struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
227 struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
228
229 u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
230
231 bool radar_enabled;
232
233 u8 drv_priv[0] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
234 };
235
236 /**
237 * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
238 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
239 * exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
240 * needs to be switched from one to the other.
241 * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
242 * to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
243 * will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
244 * from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
245 * implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
246 * hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
247 * will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
248 * for changes/removal.)
249 */
250 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
251 CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
252 CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
253 };
254
255 /**
256 * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
257 *
258 * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
259 * needs to switch from one chanctx to another. The
260 * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
261 * done.
262 *
263 * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
264 * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
265 * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
266 */
267 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
268 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
269 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
270 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
271 };
272
273 /**
274 * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
275 *
276 * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed() callback
277 * to indicate which BSS parameter changed.
278 *
279 * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
280 * also implies a change in the AID.
281 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
282 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
283 * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
284 * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
285 * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
286 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
287 * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
288 * reason (IBSS and managed mode)
289 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
290 * new beacon (beaconing modes)
291 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
292 * enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
293 * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
294 * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
295 * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
296 * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
297 * that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
298 * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
299 * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
300 * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
301 * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
302 * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
303 * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
304 * changed
305 * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
306 * currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
307 * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
308 * note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
309 * context had been assigned.
310 * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
311 * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
312 * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
313 * keep alive) changed.
314 * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
315 * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fime timing reasurement request responder
316 * functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
317 * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
318 * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
319 *
320 */
321 enum ieee80211_bss_change {
322 BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC = 1<<0,
323 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT = 1<<1,
324 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE = 1<<2,
325 BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT = 1<<3,
326 BSS_CHANGED_HT = 1<<4,
327 BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES = 1<<5,
328 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT = 1<<6,
329 BSS_CHANGED_BSSID = 1<<7,
330 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON = 1<<8,
331 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED = 1<<9,
332 BSS_CHANGED_CQM = 1<<10,
333 BSS_CHANGED_IBSS = 1<<11,
334 BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER = 1<<12,
335 BSS_CHANGED_QOS = 1<<13,
336 BSS_CHANGED_IDLE = 1<<14,
337 BSS_CHANGED_SSID = 1<<15,
338 BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP = 1<<16,
339 BSS_CHANGED_PS = 1<<17,
340 BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER = 1<<18,
341 BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS = 1<<19,
342 BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO = 1<<20,
343 BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH = 1<<21,
344 BSS_CHANGED_OCB = 1<<22,
345 BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS = 1<<23,
346 BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE = 1<<24,
347 BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE = 1<<25,
348 BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER = 1<<26,
349 BSS_CHANGED_TWT = 1<<27,
350 BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD = 1<<28,
351
352 /* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
353 };
354
355 /*
356 * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
357 * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
358 * filtering will be disabled.
359 */
360 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
361
362 /**
363 * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
364 * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
365 * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
366 * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
367 * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
368 * they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
369 * once each time the timeout triggers.
370 */
371 enum ieee80211_event_type {
372 RSSI_EVENT,
373 MLME_EVENT,
374 BAR_RX_EVENT,
375 BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
376 };
377
378 /**
379 * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
380 * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
381 * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
382 */
383 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
384 RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
385 RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
386 };
387
388 /**
389 * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
390 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
391 */
392 struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
393 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
394 };
395
396 /**
397 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
398 * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
399 * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
400 * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
401 * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
402 */
403 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
404 AUTH_EVENT,
405 ASSOC_EVENT,
406 DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
407 DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
408 };
409
410 /**
411 * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
412 * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
413 * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
414 * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
415 */
416 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
417 MLME_SUCCESS,
418 MLME_DENIED,
419 MLME_TIMEOUT,
420 };
421
422 /**
423 * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
424 * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
425 * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
426 * @reason: the reason code if applicable
427 */
428 struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
429 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
430 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
431 u16 reason;
432 };
433
434 /**
435 * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
436 * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
437 * @tid: the tid
438 * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
439 */
440 struct ieee80211_ba_event {
441 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
442 u16 tid;
443 u16 ssn;
444 };
445
446 /**
447 * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
448 * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
449 * @rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
450 * @mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
451 * @ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
452 * @u:union holding the fields above
453 */
454 struct ieee80211_event {
455 enum ieee80211_event_type type;
456 union {
457 struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
458 struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
459 struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
460 } u;
461 };
462
463 /**
464 * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
465 *
466 * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
467 *
468 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
469 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
470 */
471 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
472 u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
473 u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
474 };
475
476 /**
477 * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
478 *
479 * @lci: LCI subelement content
480 * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
481 * @lci_len: LCI data length
482 * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
483 */
484 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
485 const u8 *lci;
486 const u8 *civicloc;
487 size_t lci_len;
488 size_t civicloc_len;
489 };
490
491 /**
492 * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
493 *
494 * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
495 * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
496 *
497 * @bss_color: 6-bit value to mark inter-BSS frame, if BSS supports HE
498 * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
499 * @multi_sta_back_32bit: supports BA bitmap of 32-bits in Multi-STA BACK
500 * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
501 * @ack_enabled: indicates support to receive a multi-TID that solicits either
502 * ACK, BACK or both
503 * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
504 * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
505 * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
506 * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
507 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
508 * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
509 * mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
510 * @assoc: association status
511 * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS
512 * or not
513 * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
514 * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
515 * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
516 * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
517 * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
518 * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
519 * valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
520 * with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
521 * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
522 * as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
523 * HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
524 * only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
525 * association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
526 * %BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
527 * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
528 * the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
529 * (see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
530 * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
531 * is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
532 * IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
533 * by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
534 * guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
535 * @beacon_int: beacon interval
536 * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
537 * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
538 * index into the rate table configured by the driver in
539 * the current band.
540 * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
541 * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
542 * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
543 * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
544 * @chandef: Channel definition for this BSS -- the hardware might be
545 * configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
546 * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
547 * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
548 * This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
549 * Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
550 * be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
551 * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
552 * implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
553 * cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
554 * relation to the newly configured threshold.
555 * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
556 * implies disabled. This is an alternative mechanism to the single
557 * threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
558 * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
559 * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
560 * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
561 * may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
562 * The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
563 * to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
564 * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
565 * may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
566 * array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
567 * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
568 * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
569 * hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
570 * your driver/device needs to do.
571 * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
572 * offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
573 * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
574 * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
575 * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
576 * @txpower: TX power in dBm
577 * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
578 * Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
579 * TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
580 * NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
581 * userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
582 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
583 * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
584 * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
585 * to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
586 * if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
587 * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
588 * transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
589 * In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
590 * a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
591 * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
592 * protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
593 * station.
594 * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
595 * responder functionality.
596 * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
597 * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
598 * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
599 * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
600 * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
601 * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
602 * nontransmitted BSSIDs
603 * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
604 * in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
605 * @he_operation: HE operation information of the AP we are connected to
606 * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
607 */
608 struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
609 const u8 *bssid;
610 u8 bss_color;
611 u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
612 bool multi_sta_back_32bit;
613 bool uora_exists;
614 bool ack_enabled;
615 u8 uora_ocw_range;
616 u16 frame_time_rts_th;
617 bool he_support;
618 bool twt_requester;
619 bool twt_responder;
620 /* association related data */
621 bool assoc, ibss_joined;
622 bool ibss_creator;
623 u16 aid;
624 /* erp related data */
625 bool use_cts_prot;
626 bool use_short_preamble;
627 bool use_short_slot;
628 bool enable_beacon;
629 u8 dtim_period;
630 u16 beacon_int;
631 u16 assoc_capability;
632 u64 sync_tsf;
633 u32 sync_device_ts;
634 u8 sync_dtim_count;
635 u32 basic_rates;
636 struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
637 int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
638 u16 ht_operation_mode;
639 s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
640 u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
641 s32 cqm_rssi_low;
642 s32 cqm_rssi_high;
643 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
644 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
645 __be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
646 int arp_addr_cnt;
647 bool qos;
648 bool idle;
649 bool ps;
650 u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
651 size_t ssid_len;
652 bool hidden_ssid;
653 int txpower;
654 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
655 struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
656 bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
657 u16 max_idle_period;
658 bool protected_keep_alive;
659 bool ftm_responder;
660 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
661 /* Multiple BSSID data */
662 bool nontransmitted;
663 u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
664 u8 bssid_index;
665 u8 bssid_indicator;
666 bool ema_ap;
667 u8 profile_periodicity;
668 struct ieee80211_he_operation he_operation;
669 struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
670 };
671
672 /**
673 * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
674 *
675 * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
676 *
677 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
678 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
679 * number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
680 * number and increasing the sequence number only when the
681 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
682 * assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
683 * for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
684 * that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
685 * If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
686 * assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
687 * 802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
688 * beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
689 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
690 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
691 * station
692 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
693 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
694 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
695 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
696 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
697 * because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
698 * avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
699 * firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
700 * went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
701 * the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
702 * that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
703 * since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
704 * hardware queue.
705 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
706 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
707 * is for the whole aggregation.
708 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
709 * so consider using block ack request (BAR).
710 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
711 * set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
712 * be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
713 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
714 * that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
715 * off-channel operation.
716 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
717 * used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
718 * it can be sent out.
719 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
720 * used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
721 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
722 * used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
723 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
724 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
725 * be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
726 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
727 * transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
728 * by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
729 * queue gets full.
730 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
731 * after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
732 * be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
733 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
734 * code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
735 * should kick the MLME state machine.
736 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
737 * MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
738 * status to user space)
739 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
740 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
741 * frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
742 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
743 * the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
744 * in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
745 * handled properly by the device.
746 * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
747 * testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
748 * TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
749 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
750 * This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
751 * frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
752 * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
753 * when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
754 * an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
755 * the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
756 * PS-Poll responses.
757 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
758 * This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
759 * the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
760 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
761 * would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
762 * monitor injection).
763 * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
764 * IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
765 * any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
766 * This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
767 * behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
768 *
769 * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
770 * forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
771 */
772 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
773 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS = BIT(0),
774 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ = BIT(1),
775 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK = BIT(2),
776 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT = BIT(3),
777 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT = BIT(4),
778 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM = BIT(5),
779 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU = BIT(6),
780 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED = BIT(7),
781 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED = BIT(8),
782 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK = BIT(9),
783 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU = BIT(10),
784 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK = BIT(11),
785 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE = BIT(12),
786 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK = BIT(13),
787 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING = BIT(14),
788 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED = BIT(15),
789 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT = BIT(16),
790 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER = BIT(17),
791 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES = BIT(18),
792 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION = BIT(19),
793 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX = BIT(20),
794 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX = BIT(21),
795 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC = BIT(22),
796 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC = BIT(23) | BIT(24),
797 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN = BIT(25),
798 IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE = BIT(26),
799 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE = BIT(27),
800 IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP = BIT(28),
801 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE = BIT(29),
802 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG = BIT(30),
803 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED = BIT(31),
804 };
805
806 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT 23
807
808 /**
809 * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
810 *
811 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
812 * protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
813 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
814 * frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
815 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
816 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
817 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
818 * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
819 *
820 * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
821 */
822 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
823 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO = BIT(0),
824 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE = BIT(1),
825 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT = BIT(2),
826 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU = BIT(3),
827 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT = BIT(4),
828 IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP = BIT(5),
829 };
830
831 /*
832 * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
833 * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
834 */
835 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK | \
836 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT | \
837 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU | \
838 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK | \
839 IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK | \
840 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER | \
841 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC | \
842 IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
843
844 /**
845 * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
846 * Rate Control algorithm.
847 *
848 * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
849 * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
850 *
851 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
852 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
853 * This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
854 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
855 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
856 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
857 * into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
858 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
859 * Greenfield mode.
860 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
861 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
862 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
863 * (80+80 isn't supported yet)
864 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
865 * adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
866 * NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
867 * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
868 */
869 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
870 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS = BIT(0),
871 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT = BIT(1),
872 IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE = BIT(2),
873
874 /* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
875 IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS = BIT(3),
876 IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD = BIT(4),
877 IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(5),
878 IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA = BIT(6),
879 IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI = BIT(7),
880 IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS = BIT(8),
881 IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(9),
882 IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH = BIT(10),
883 };
884
885
886 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
887 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
888
889 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
890 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
891
892 /* maximum number of rate stages */
893 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES 4
894
895 /* maximum number of rate table entries */
896 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE 4
897
898 /**
899 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
900 *
901 * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
902 * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
903 * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
904 *
905 * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
906 * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
907 *
908 * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
909 * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
910 *
911 * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
912 * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
913 * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
914 * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
915 * information::
916 *
917 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
918 *
919 * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
920 * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
921 * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
922 * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
923 * information should then contain::
924 *
925 * { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
926 *
927 * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
928 * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
929 */
930 struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
931 s8 idx;
932 u16 count:5,
933 flags:11;
934 } __packed;
935
936 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY 31
937
ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate,u8 mcs,u8 nss)938 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
939 u8 mcs, u8 nss)
940 {
941 WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
942 WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
943 rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
944 }
945
946 static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)947 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
948 {
949 return rate->idx & 0xF;
950 }
951
952 static inline u8
ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate * rate)953 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
954 {
955 return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
956 }
957
958 /**
959 * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
960 *
961 * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
962 * (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
963 * (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
964 * (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
965 *
966 * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
967 * @band: the band to transmit on (use for checking for races)
968 * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
969 * @ack_frame_id: internal frame ID for TX status, used internally
970 * @control: union part for control data
971 * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
972 * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
973 * @control.use_rts: use RTS
974 * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
975 * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
976 * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
977 * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
978 * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
979 * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
980 * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
981 * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
982 * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
983 * @pad: padding
984 * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
985 * @status: union part for status data
986 * @status.rates: attempted rates
987 * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
988 * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
989 * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
990 * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
991 * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission
992 * @status.is_valid_ack_signal: ACK signal is valid
993 * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
994 * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
995 * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
996 * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
997 * @ampdu_ack_len: number of acked aggregated frames.
998 * relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
999 * @ampdu_len: number of aggregated frames.
1000 * relevant only if IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU was set.
1001 * @ack_signal: signal strength of the ACK frame
1002 */
1003 struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1004 /* common information */
1005 u32 flags;
1006 u8 band;
1007
1008 u8 hw_queue;
1009
1010 u16 ack_frame_id;
1011
1012 union {
1013 struct {
1014 union {
1015 /* rate control */
1016 struct {
1017 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1018 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1019 s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1020 u8 use_rts:1;
1021 u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1022 u8 short_preamble:1;
1023 u8 skip_table:1;
1024 /* 2 bytes free */
1025 };
1026 /* only needed before rate control */
1027 unsigned long jiffies;
1028 };
1029 /* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1030 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1031 struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1032 u32 flags;
1033 codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1034 } control;
1035 struct {
1036 u64 cookie;
1037 } ack;
1038 struct {
1039 struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1040 s32 ack_signal;
1041 u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1042 u8 ampdu_len;
1043 u8 antenna;
1044 u16 tx_time;
1045 bool is_valid_ack_signal;
1046 void *status_driver_data[19 / sizeof(void *)];
1047 } status;
1048 struct {
1049 struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1050 IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1051 u8 pad[4];
1052
1053 void *rate_driver_data[
1054 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1055 };
1056 void *driver_data[
1057 IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1058 };
1059 };
1060
1061 /**
1062 * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx staus info for rate control
1063 *
1064 * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1065 * @info: Basic tx status information
1066 * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1067 * @rate: The TX rate that was used when sending the packet
1068 */
1069 struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1070 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1071 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1072 struct sk_buff *skb;
1073 struct rate_info *rate;
1074 };
1075
1076 /**
1077 * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1078 *
1079 * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1080 * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1081 * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1082 *
1083 * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1084 * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1085 * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1086 * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1087 */
1088 struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1089 const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1090 size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1091 const u8 *common_ies;
1092 size_t common_ie_len;
1093 };
1094
1095
IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff * skb)1096 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1097 {
1098 return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1099 }
1100
IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff * skb)1101 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1102 {
1103 return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1104 }
1105
1106 /**
1107 * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1108 *
1109 * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1110 *
1111 * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1112 * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1113 * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1114 * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1115 *
1116 * NOTE: You can only use this function if you do NOT use
1117 * info->driver_data! Use info->rate_driver_data
1118 * instead if you need only the less space that allows.
1119 */
1120 static inline void
ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)1121 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1122 {
1123 int i;
1124
1125 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1126 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1127 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1128 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1129 BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1130 /* clear the rate counts */
1131 for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1132 info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1133
1134 BUILD_BUG_ON(
1135 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.ack_signal) != 20);
1136 memset(&info->status.ampdu_ack_len, 0,
1137 sizeof(struct ieee80211_tx_info) -
1138 offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.ampdu_ack_len));
1139 }
1140
1141
1142 /**
1143 * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1144 *
1145 * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1146 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1147 * Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1148 * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1149 * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1150 * verification has been done by the hardware.
1151 * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1152 * If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1153 * hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1154 * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1155 * flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1156 * Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1157 * is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1158 * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1159 * de-duplication by itself.
1160 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1161 * the frame.
1162 * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1163 * the frame.
1164 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1165 * field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1166 * was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1167 * merging.
1168 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1169 * field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1170 * (including FCS) was received.
1171 * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1172 * field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1173 * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1174 * Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1175 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1176 * number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1177 * each A-MPDU
1178 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1179 * subframes of a single A-MPDU
1180 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1181 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1182 * on this subframe
1183 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC
1184 * is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field)
1185 * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1186 * done by the hardware
1187 * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1188 * processing it in any regular way.
1189 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1190 * them for sniffing purposes.
1191 * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1192 * monitor interfaces.
1193 * This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1194 * them for sniffing purposes.
1195 * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1196 * subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1197 * All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1198 * if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1199 * the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1200 * deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1201 * subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1202 * either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1203 * interleaved with other frames.
1204 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VENDOR_DATA: This frame contains vendor-specific
1205 * radiotap data in the skb->data (before the frame) as described by
1206 * the &struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap.
1207 * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1208 * This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1209 * the first subframe.
1210 * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1211 * be done in the hardware.
1212 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1213 * frame
1214 * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1215 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1216 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1217 *
1218 * - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1219 * - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1220 * - DATA3_CODING
1221 * - DATA5_GI
1222 * - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1223 * - DATA6_NSTS
1224 * - DATA3_STBC
1225 *
1226 * from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1227 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1228 * (&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1229 * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1230 * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1231 * the "0-length PSDU" field included there. The value for it is
1232 * in &struct ieee80211_rx_status. Note that if this value isn't
1233 * known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1234 */
1235 enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1236 RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR = BIT(0),
1237 RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED = BIT(1),
1238 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START = BIT(2),
1239 RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED = BIT(3),
1240 RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED = BIT(4),
1241 RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC = BIT(5),
1242 RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC = BIT(6),
1243 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START = BIT(7),
1244 RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL = BIT(8),
1245 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS = BIT(9),
1246 RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED = BIT(10),
1247 RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED = BIT(11),
1248 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN = BIT(12),
1249 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST = BIT(13),
1250 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR = BIT(14),
1251 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN = BIT(15),
1252 RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END = BIT(16),
1253 RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR = BIT(17),
1254 RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR = BIT(18),
1255 RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE = BIT(19),
1256 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VENDOR_DATA = BIT(20),
1257 RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED = BIT(21),
1258 RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN = BIT(22),
1259 RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED = BIT(23),
1260 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT = BIT(24),
1261 RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN = BIT(25),
1262 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE = BIT(26),
1263 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU = BIT(27),
1264 RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG = BIT(28),
1265 RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU = BIT(29),
1266 };
1267
1268 /**
1269 * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1270 *
1271 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1272 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1273 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1274 * if the driver fills this value it should add
1275 * %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1276 * to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1277 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1278 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1279 * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1280 */
1281 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1282 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE = BIT(0),
1283 RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI = BIT(2),
1284 RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF = BIT(3),
1285 RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK = BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1286 RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC = BIT(6),
1287 RX_ENC_FLAG_BF = BIT(7),
1288 };
1289
1290 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT 4
1291
1292 enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1293 RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1294 RX_ENC_HT,
1295 RX_ENC_VHT,
1296 RX_ENC_HE,
1297 };
1298
1299 /**
1300 * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1301 *
1302 * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1303 * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1304 * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1305 *
1306 * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1307 * (TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1308 * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1309 * needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1310 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1311 * it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1312 * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1313 * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1314 * This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1315 * for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1316 * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1317 * unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1318 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1319 * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1320 * values were filled.
1321 * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1322 * support dB or unspecified units)
1323 * @antenna: antenna used
1324 * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1325 * HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1326 * @nss: number of streams (VHT and HE only)
1327 * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1328 * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1329 * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1330 * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1331 * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1332 * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1333 * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1334 * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1335 * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1336 * each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1337 * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC
1338 * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1339 */
1340 struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1341 u64 mactime;
1342 u64 boottime_ns;
1343 u32 device_timestamp;
1344 u32 ampdu_reference;
1345 u32 flag;
1346 u16 freq;
1347 u8 enc_flags;
1348 u8 encoding:2, bw:3, he_ru:3;
1349 u8 he_gi:2, he_dcm:1;
1350 u8 rate_idx;
1351 u8 nss;
1352 u8 rx_flags;
1353 u8 band;
1354 u8 antenna;
1355 s8 signal;
1356 u8 chains;
1357 s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1358 u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc;
1359 u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1360 };
1361
1362 /**
1363 * struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap - vendor radiotap data information
1364 * @present: presence bitmap for this vendor namespace
1365 * (this could be extended in the future if any vendor needs more
1366 * bits, the radiotap spec does allow for that)
1367 * @align: radiotap vendor namespace alignment. This defines the needed
1368 * alignment for the @data field below, not for the vendor namespace
1369 * description itself (which has a fixed 2-byte alignment)
1370 * Must be a power of two, and be set to at least 1!
1371 * @oui: radiotap vendor namespace OUI
1372 * @subns: radiotap vendor sub namespace
1373 * @len: radiotap vendor sub namespace skip length, if alignment is done
1374 * then that's added to this, i.e. this is only the length of the
1375 * @data field.
1376 * @pad: number of bytes of padding after the @data, this exists so that
1377 * the skb data alignment can be preserved even if the data has odd
1378 * length
1379 * @data: the actual vendor namespace data
1380 *
1381 * This struct, including the vendor data, goes into the skb->data before
1382 * the 802.11 header. It's split up in mac80211 using the align/oui/subns
1383 * data.
1384 */
1385 struct ieee80211_vendor_radiotap {
1386 u32 present;
1387 u8 align;
1388 u8 oui[3];
1389 u8 subns;
1390 u8 pad;
1391 u16 len;
1392 u8 data[];
1393 } __packed;
1394
1395 /**
1396 * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1397 *
1398 * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1399 *
1400 * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1401 * to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1402 * or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1403 * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1404 * This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1405 * meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1406 * transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1407 * Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1408 * driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1409 * for more.
1410 * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1411 * the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1412 * may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1413 * be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1414 * it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1415 * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1416 * operating channel.
1417 */
1418 enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1419 IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR = (1<<0),
1420 IEEE80211_CONF_PS = (1<<1),
1421 IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE = (1<<2),
1422 IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL = (1<<3),
1423 };
1424
1425
1426 /**
1427 * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1428 *
1429 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1430 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1431 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1432 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1433 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1434 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1435 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1436 * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1437 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1438 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1439 */
1440 enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1441 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS = BIT(1),
1442 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL = BIT(2),
1443 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR = BIT(3),
1444 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS = BIT(4),
1445 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER = BIT(5),
1446 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL = BIT(6),
1447 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS = BIT(7),
1448 IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE = BIT(8),
1449 };
1450
1451 /**
1452 * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1453 *
1454 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1455 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1456 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1457 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1458 * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1459 */
1460 enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1461 IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1462 IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1463 IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1464 IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1465
1466 /* keep last */
1467 IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1468 };
1469
1470 /**
1471 * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1472 *
1473 * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1474 *
1475 * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1476 *
1477 * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1478 * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1479 * in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1480 * has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1481 * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1482 * powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1483 * the CONF_PS flag is set.
1484 *
1485 * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1486 * value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1487 *
1488 * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1489 * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1490 *
1491 * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1492 * (a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1493 * but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1494 * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1495 * frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1496 * number of transmissions not the number of retries
1497 *
1498 * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1499 * %IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1500 * configured for an HT channel.
1501 * Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1502 * otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1503 */
1504 struct ieee80211_conf {
1505 u32 flags;
1506 int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1507
1508 u16 listen_interval;
1509 u8 ps_dtim_period;
1510
1511 u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1512
1513 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1514 bool radar_enabled;
1515 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1516 };
1517
1518 /**
1519 * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1520 *
1521 * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1522 * operation.
1523 *
1524 * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1525 * Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1526 * announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1527 * the driver passed into mac80211.
1528 * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1529 * rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1530 * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1531 * scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1532 * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1533 * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1534 * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1535 * current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1536 * channel, expressed in TU.
1537 */
1538 struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1539 u64 timestamp;
1540 u32 device_timestamp;
1541 bool block_tx;
1542 struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1543 u8 count;
1544 u32 delay;
1545 };
1546
1547 /**
1548 * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1549 *
1550 * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1551 * on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1552 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1553 * monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1554 * connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1555 * provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1556 * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1557 * interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1558 * but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1559 * only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1560 * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1561 * and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1562 * this is not pure P2P vif.
1563 */
1564 enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1565 IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER = BIT(0),
1566 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI = BIT(1),
1567 IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD = BIT(2),
1568 IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE = BIT(3),
1569 };
1570
1571 /**
1572 * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1573 *
1574 * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1575 * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1576 *
1577 * @type: type of this virtual interface
1578 * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1579 * or the BSS we're associated to
1580 * @addr: address of this interface
1581 * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1582 * interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1583 * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on. Internally it is
1584 * write-protected by sdata_lock and local->mtx so holding either is fine
1585 * for read access.
1586 * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
1587 * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
1588 * these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
1589 * or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
1590 * at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
1591 * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
1592 * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
1593 * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
1594 * when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
1595 * path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
1596 * be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
1597 * processed after it switches back to %NULL.
1598 * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
1599 * interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
1600 * monitor interface (if that is requested.)
1601 * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
1602 * interface.
1603 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
1604 * sizeof(void \*).
1605 * @txq: the multicast data TX queue (if driver uses the TXQ abstraction)
1606 * @txqs_stopped: per AC flag to indicate that intermediate TXQs are stopped,
1607 * protected by fq->lock.
1608 */
1609 struct ieee80211_vif {
1610 enum nl80211_iftype type;
1611 struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
1612 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1613 bool p2p;
1614 bool csa_active;
1615 bool mu_mimo_owner;
1616
1617 u8 cab_queue;
1618 u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
1619
1620 struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
1621
1622 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
1623
1624 u32 driver_flags;
1625
1626 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
1627 struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
1628 #endif
1629
1630 unsigned int probe_req_reg;
1631
1632 bool txqs_stopped[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
1633
1634 /* must be last */
1635 u8 drv_priv[0] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
1636 };
1637
ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)1638 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1639 {
1640 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
1641 return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
1642 #endif
1643 return false;
1644 }
1645
1646 /**
1647 * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
1648 * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
1649 *
1650 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1651 * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
1652 *
1653 * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't
1654 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
1655 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
1656 */
1657 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
1658
1659 /**
1660 * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
1661 * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
1662 *
1663 * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
1664 * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
1665 *
1666 * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't
1667 * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
1668 * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
1669 */
1670 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
1671
1672 /**
1673 * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
1674 *
1675 * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
1676 * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
1677 *
1678 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
1679 * driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
1680 * particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
1681 * will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
1682 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
1683 * the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
1684 * generation in software.
1685 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
1686 * that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
1687 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
1688 * CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
1689 * (MFP) to be done in software.
1690 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
1691 * if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
1692 * itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
1693 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
1694 * not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
1695 * MIC.
1696 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
1697 * management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
1698 * crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
1699 * properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
1700 * fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
1701 * RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
1702 * %IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
1703 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
1704 * driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
1705 * only for managment frames (MFP).
1706 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
1707 * driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
1708 * be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
1709 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
1710 * a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
1711 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
1712 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
1713 * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
1714 * for a AES_CMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence number
1715 * generation only
1716 */
1717 enum ieee80211_key_flags {
1718 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT = BIT(0),
1719 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV = BIT(1),
1720 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC = BIT(2),
1721 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE = BIT(3),
1722 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX = BIT(4),
1723 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE = BIT(5),
1724 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT = BIT(6),
1725 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM = BIT(7),
1726 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE = BIT(8),
1727 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX = BIT(9),
1728 IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE = BIT(10),
1729 };
1730
1731 /**
1732 * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
1733 *
1734 * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
1735 * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
1736 *
1737 * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
1738 * wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
1739 * encrypted in hardware.
1740 * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
1741 * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
1742 * needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
1743 * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
1744 * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
1745 * @keylen: key material length
1746 * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
1747 * data block:
1748 * - Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
1749 * - Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
1750 * - Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
1751 * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
1752 * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
1753 */
1754 struct ieee80211_key_conf {
1755 atomic64_t tx_pn;
1756 u32 cipher;
1757 u8 icv_len;
1758 u8 iv_len;
1759 u8 hw_key_idx;
1760 s8 keyidx;
1761 u16 flags;
1762 u8 keylen;
1763 u8 key[0];
1764 };
1765
1766 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN 16
1767
1768 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
1769 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
1770
1771 /**
1772 * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
1773 *
1774 * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
1775 * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
1776 * reverse order than in packet)
1777 * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
1778 * reverse order than in packet)
1779 * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
1780 * reverse order than in packet)
1781 * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
1782 * reverse order than in packet)
1783 * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
1784 */
1785 struct ieee80211_key_seq {
1786 union {
1787 struct {
1788 u32 iv32;
1789 u16 iv16;
1790 } tkip;
1791 struct {
1792 u8 pn[6];
1793 } ccmp;
1794 struct {
1795 u8 pn[6];
1796 } aes_cmac;
1797 struct {
1798 u8 pn[6];
1799 } aes_gmac;
1800 struct {
1801 u8 pn[6];
1802 } gcmp;
1803 struct {
1804 u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
1805 u8 seq_len;
1806 } hw;
1807 };
1808 };
1809
1810 /**
1811 * struct ieee80211_cipher_scheme - cipher scheme
1812 *
1813 * This structure contains a cipher scheme information defining
1814 * the secure packet crypto handling.
1815 *
1816 * @cipher: a cipher suite selector
1817 * @iftype: a cipher iftype bit mask indicating an allowed cipher usage
1818 * @hdr_len: a length of a security header used the cipher
1819 * @pn_len: a length of a packet number in the security header
1820 * @pn_off: an offset of pn from the beginning of the security header
1821 * @key_idx_off: an offset of key index byte in the security header
1822 * @key_idx_mask: a bit mask of key_idx bits
1823 * @key_idx_shift: a bit shift needed to get key_idx
1824 * key_idx value calculation:
1825 * (sec_header_base[key_idx_off] & key_idx_mask) >> key_idx_shift
1826 * @mic_len: a mic length in bytes
1827 */
1828 struct ieee80211_cipher_scheme {
1829 u32 cipher;
1830 u16 iftype;
1831 u8 hdr_len;
1832 u8 pn_len;
1833 u8 pn_off;
1834 u8 key_idx_off;
1835 u8 key_idx_mask;
1836 u8 key_idx_shift;
1837 u8 mic_len;
1838 };
1839
1840 /**
1841 * enum set_key_cmd - key command
1842 *
1843 * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
1844 * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
1845 *
1846 * @SET_KEY: a key is set
1847 * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
1848 */
1849 enum set_key_cmd {
1850 SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
1851 };
1852
1853 /**
1854 * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
1855 *
1856 * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
1857 * this is a special state for add/remove transitions
1858 * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
1859 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
1860 * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
1861 * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
1862 */
1863 enum ieee80211_sta_state {
1864 /* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
1865 IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
1866 IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
1867 IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
1868 IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
1869 IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
1870 };
1871
1872 /**
1873 * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
1874 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
1875 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
1876 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
1877 * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
1878 * (including 80+80 MHz)
1879 *
1880 * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
1881 * correctly, the values must be sorted.
1882 */
1883 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
1884 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
1885 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
1886 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
1887 IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
1888 };
1889
1890 /**
1891 * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
1892 *
1893 * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
1894 * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
1895 * Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
1896 */
1897 struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
1898 struct rcu_head rcu_head;
1899 struct {
1900 s8 idx;
1901 u8 count;
1902 u8 count_cts;
1903 u8 count_rts;
1904 u16 flags;
1905 } rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
1906 };
1907
1908 /**
1909 * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
1910 *
1911 * Used to configure txpower for station.
1912 *
1913 * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
1914 * to the STA.
1915 * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
1916 * will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
1917 * %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
1918 * NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
1919 * per peer TPC.
1920 */
1921 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
1922 s16 power;
1923 enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
1924 };
1925
1926 /**
1927 * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
1928 *
1929 * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
1930 * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
1931 * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
1932 * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
1933 * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
1934 * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
1935 *
1936 * @addr: MAC address
1937 * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
1938 * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates (per band)
1939 * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
1940 * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
1941 * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
1942 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
1943 * that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
1944 * Can be modified by driver.
1945 * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
1946 * otherwise always false)
1947 * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
1948 * sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
1949 * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
1950 * if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
1951 * IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
1952 * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
1953 * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
1954 * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
1955 * station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
1956 * notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
1957 * the station moves to associated state.
1958 * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
1959 * @rates: rate control selection table
1960 * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
1961 * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
1962 * valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
1963 * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
1964 * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
1965 * A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
1966 * unlimited.
1967 * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
1968 * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
1969 * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
1970 * @txq: per-TID data TX queues (if driver uses the TXQ abstraction); note that
1971 * the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS) is used for non-data frames
1972 */
1973 struct ieee80211_sta {
1974 u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1975 u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
1976 u16 aid;
1977 struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
1978 struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
1979 struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
1980 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
1981 bool wme;
1982 u8 uapsd_queues;
1983 u8 max_sp;
1984 u8 rx_nss;
1985 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
1986 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1987 struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
1988 bool tdls;
1989 bool tdls_initiator;
1990 bool mfp;
1991 u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
1992
1993 /**
1994 * @max_amsdu_len:
1995 * indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
1996 * This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
1997 * For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
1998 *
1999 * * If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2000 * A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2001 * * If the skb is not part of a BA aggreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2002 * size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2003 *
2004 * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2005 * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2006 * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2007 */
2008 u16 max_amsdu_len;
2009 bool support_p2p_ps;
2010 u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2011 u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2012 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2013
2014 struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2015
2016 /* must be last */
2017 u8 drv_priv[0] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2018 };
2019
2020 /**
2021 * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2022 *
2023 * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2024 * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2025 *
2026 * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2027 * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2028 */
2029 enum sta_notify_cmd {
2030 STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2031 };
2032
2033 /**
2034 * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2035 *
2036 * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2037 * it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2038 */
2039 struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2040 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2041 };
2042
2043 /**
2044 * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2045 *
2046 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2047 * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2048 * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2049 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2050 * @ac: the AC for this queue
2051 * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2052 *
2053 * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2054 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2055 */
2056 struct ieee80211_txq {
2057 struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2058 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2059 u8 tid;
2060 u8 ac;
2061
2062 /* must be last */
2063 u8 drv_priv[0] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2064 };
2065
2066 /**
2067 * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2068 *
2069 * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2070 * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2071 * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2072 * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2073 * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2074 *
2075 * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2076 * The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2077 * controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2078 * should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2079 * will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2080 * algorithm.
2081 * Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2082 * callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2083 * the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2084 * @use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2085 * timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2086 * CCK frames.
2087 *
2088 * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2089 * Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2090 * the FCS at the end.
2091 *
2092 * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2093 * Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2094 * for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2095 * rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2096 * to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2097 * multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2098 * the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2099 *
2100 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2101 * Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2102 * expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2103 * If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2104 *
2105 * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2106 * Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2107 * one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2108 * between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2109 *
2110 * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2111 * Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2112 * Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2113 *
2114 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2115 * Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2116 *
2117 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2118 * Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2119 *
2120 * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2121 * Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2122 * stack support for dynamic PS.
2123 *
2124 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2125 * Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2126 *
2127 * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2128 * Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2129 *
2130 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2131 * Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2132 * the stack.
2133 *
2134 * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2135 * The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2136 * periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2137 *
2138 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2139 * This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2140 * dtim_period).
2141 *
2142 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2143 * per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2144 * the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2145 * to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2146 * possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2147 * only in that case.
2148 *
2149 * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2150 * autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2151 * this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2152 * stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2153 * Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2154 * the PS mode of connected stations.
2155 *
2156 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2157 * setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2158 * software.
2159 *
2160 * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2161 * a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2162 * active interfaces.
2163 *
2164 * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2165 * be created. It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2166 * desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2167 *
2168 * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2169 * crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2170 * try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2171 * the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2172 * supported cipher suites.
2173 *
2174 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2175 * this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2176 * for frames.
2177 *
2178 * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2179 * queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2180 * for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2181 * control for more details.
2182 *
2183 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2184 * selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2185 *
2186 * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2187 * P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2188 * is supported.
2189 *
2190 * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2191 * only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2192 *
2193 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2194 * and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2195 * using aggregation for such frames.)
2196 *
2197 * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2198 * for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2199 * is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2200 * CSA frame.
2201 *
2202 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2203 * or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2204 *
2205 * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2206 * in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2207 *
2208 * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2209 * than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2210 *
2211 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2212 * within A-MPDU.
2213 *
2214 * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2215 * for sent beacons.
2216 *
2217 * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2218 * station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2219 * by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2220 * from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2221 *
2222 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2223 * reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2224 * order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2225 * timeout.
2226 *
2227 * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2228 * which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2229 *
2230 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2231 * A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2232 * When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2233 * limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2234 * max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2235 *
2236 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2237 * skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2238 *
2239 * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2240 * by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2241 * drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2242 * is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2243 *
2244 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2245 * The stack will not do fragmentation.
2246 * The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2247 *
2248 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2249 * TDLS links.
2250 *
2251 * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the
2252 * mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a
2253 * deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no
2254 * beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the
2255 * virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of
2256 * the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the
2257 * deauthentication frame might not be transmitted.
2258 *
2259 * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2260 * support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2261 *
2262 * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2263 * course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2264 *
2265 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2266 * extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2267 * the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2268 * but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2269 * See also the documentation for that flag.
2270 *
2271 * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2272 * MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2273 * TXQs to start with.
2274 *
2275 * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2276 * length in tx status information
2277 *
2278 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2279 *
2280 * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2281 * only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2282 *
2283 * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2284 * aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2285 * A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2286 *
2287 * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2288 */
2289 enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2290 IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2291 IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2292 IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2293 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2294 IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2295 IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2296 IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2297 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2298 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2299 IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2300 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2301 IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2302 IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2303 IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2304 IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2305 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2306 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2307 IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2308 IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2309 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2310 IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2311 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2312 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2313 IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2314 IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2315 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2316 IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2317 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2318 IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2319 IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2320 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2321 IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2322 IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2323 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2324 IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2325 IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2326 IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2327 IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2328 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2329 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2330 IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP,
2331 IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2332 IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2333 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2334 IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2335 IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2336 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2337 IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2338 IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2339
2340 /* keep last, obviously */
2341 NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2342 };
2343
2344 /**
2345 * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2346 *
2347 * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2348 * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2349 *
2350 * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2351 * 802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2352 * members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2353 * and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2354 * bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2355 *
2356 * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2357 *
2358 * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2359 * along with this structure.
2360 *
2361 * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2362 *
2363 * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2364 * for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2365 *
2366 * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2367 * Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2368 *
2369 * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2370 * only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2371 *
2372 * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2373 * that HW supports
2374 *
2375 * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2376 * data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2377 * queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2378 *
2379 * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2380 * If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2381 * set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2382 *
2383 * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2384 * within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2385 * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2386 * within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2387 * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2388 * within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2389 * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2390 * within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2391 *
2392 * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2393 * can handle.
2394 * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2395 * the hw can report back.
2396 * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2397 *
2398 * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2399 * sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2400 * aggregation.
2401 * This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2402 * number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2403 * it shouldn't be set.
2404 *
2405 * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2406 * aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2407 * advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2408 * the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
2409 * with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2410 * For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
2411 *
2412 * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2413 * of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2414 *
2415 * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2416 * (if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2417 *
2418 * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
2419 * reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
2420 * include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
2421 * adding _BW is supported today.
2422 *
2423 * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
2424 * the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
2425 * Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
2426 *
2427 * @radiotap_he: HE radiotap validity flags
2428 *
2429 * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
2430 * @units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
2431 * field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
2432 * device_timestamp.
2433 * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
2434 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
2435 * IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
2436 * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
2437 * radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
2438 *
2439 * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
2440 * from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
2441 * other features will be rejected during HW registration.
2442 *
2443 * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
2444 * for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
2445 * enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
2446 * Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
2447 * that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
2448 * neither enabled.
2449 *
2450 * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
2451 * deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
2452 * Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
2453 *
2454 * @n_cipher_schemes: a size of an array of cipher schemes definitions.
2455 * @cipher_schemes: a pointer to an array of cipher scheme definitions
2456 * supported by HW.
2457 * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
2458 * device.
2459 *
2460 * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
2461 * them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
2462 * unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
2463 *
2464 * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
2465 * refilling deficit of each TXQ.
2466 *
2467 * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
2468 */
2469 struct ieee80211_hw {
2470 struct ieee80211_conf conf;
2471 struct wiphy *wiphy;
2472 const char *rate_control_algorithm;
2473 void *priv;
2474 unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
2475 unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
2476 unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
2477 int vif_data_size;
2478 int sta_data_size;
2479 int chanctx_data_size;
2480 int txq_data_size;
2481 u16 queues;
2482 u16 max_listen_interval;
2483 s8 max_signal;
2484 u8 max_rates;
2485 u8 max_report_rates;
2486 u8 max_rate_tries;
2487 u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2488 u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
2489 u8 max_tx_fragments;
2490 u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
2491 u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
2492 u16 radiotap_vht_details;
2493 struct {
2494 int units_pos;
2495 s16 accuracy;
2496 } radiotap_timestamp;
2497 netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2498 u8 uapsd_queues;
2499 u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
2500 u8 n_cipher_schemes;
2501 const struct ieee80211_cipher_scheme *cipher_schemes;
2502 u8 max_nan_de_entries;
2503 u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
2504 u8 weight_multiplier;
2505 u32 max_mtu;
2506 };
2507
_ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)2508 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2509 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2510 {
2511 return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2512 }
2513 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2514
_ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)2515 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2516 enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2517 {
2518 return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2519 }
2520 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg) _ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2521
2522 /**
2523 * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
2524 *
2525 * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
2526 * @req: cfg80211 request.
2527 */
2528 struct ieee80211_scan_request {
2529 struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
2530
2531 /* Keep last */
2532 struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
2533 };
2534
2535 /**
2536 * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
2537 *
2538 * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
2539 * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
2540 * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
2541 * @status: channel-switch response status
2542 * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
2543 * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2544 * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
2545 * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
2546 * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
2547 */
2548 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
2549 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2550 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
2551 u8 action_code;
2552 u32 status;
2553 u32 timestamp;
2554 u16 switch_time;
2555 u16 switch_timeout;
2556 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
2557 u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
2558 };
2559
2560 /**
2561 * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
2562 *
2563 * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
2564 *
2565 * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
2566 * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
2567 * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
2568 * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
2569 * is already used internally by mac80211.
2570 *
2571 * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
2572 */
2573 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
2574
2575 /**
2576 * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
2577 *
2578 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
2579 * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
2580 */
SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct device * dev)2581 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
2582 {
2583 set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
2584 }
2585
2586 /**
2587 * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
2588 *
2589 * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
2590 * @addr: the address to set
2591 */
SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const u8 * addr)2592 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
2593 {
2594 memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
2595 }
2596
2597 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)2598 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2599 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
2600 {
2601 if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
2602 return NULL;
2603 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
2604 }
2605
2606 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c)2607 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2608 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
2609 {
2610 if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
2611 return NULL;
2612 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
2613 }
2614
2615 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw * hw,const struct ieee80211_tx_info * c,int idx)2616 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2617 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
2618 {
2619 if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
2620 return NULL;
2621 return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
2622 }
2623
2624 /**
2625 * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
2626 * @hw: the hardware
2627 * @skb: the skb
2628 *
2629 * Free a transmit skb. Use this funtion when some failure
2630 * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
2631 */
2632 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
2633
2634 /**
2635 * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
2636 *
2637 * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
2638 * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
2639 *
2640 * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
2641 * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
2642 * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
2643 * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
2644 * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
2645 * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
2646 * VLANs are configured for an access point.
2647 *
2648 * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
2649 * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
2650 * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
2651 *
2652 * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
2653 * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
2654 * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
2655 * hardware key index, you are free to use the full u8 range.
2656 *
2657 * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
2658 * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
2659 * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
2660 * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
2661 *
2662 * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
2663 *
2664 * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
2665 * for it has been uploaded to hardware, the stack will not make any
2666 * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
2667 * based on the receive flags.
2668 *
2669 * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
2670 * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
2671 * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
2672 * keys.
2673 *
2674 * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
2675 * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
2676 * handler.
2677 * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
2678 * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
2679 * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
2680 * rekeying), it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
2681 * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
2682 * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
2683 *
2684 * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
2685 * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
2686 * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
2687 *
2688 * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
2689 * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to to following
2690 * requirements:
2691 * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to
2692 mac80211 once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been
2693 completed when also setting @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV for any key,
2694 2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
2695 at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
2696 3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
2697 encrypted with the new key and
2698 4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
2699 Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
2700 */
2701
2702 /**
2703 * DOC: Powersave support
2704 *
2705 * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
2706 *
2707 * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself,
2708 * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
2709 * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
2710 * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
2711 * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
2712 * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
2713 * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
2714 * it finds traffic directed to it.
2715 *
2716 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
2717 * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
2718 * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
2719 * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
2720 * back to sleep at appropriate times.
2721 *
2722 * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
2723 * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
2724 * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
2725 *
2726 * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
2727 * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
2728 * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
2729 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
2730 * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
2731 * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
2732 * as best as it can, mac80211 is too slow to do that.
2733 *
2734 * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
2735 * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
2736 * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
2737 * the next wakeup. It's compromise of getting good enough latency when
2738 * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
2739 * periods.
2740 *
2741 * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
2742 * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
2743 * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
2744 * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
2745 * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
2746 * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
2747 * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
2748 * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
2749 * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
2750 * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
2751 *
2752 * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
2753 * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
2754 * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
2755 * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
2756 * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
2757 * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
2758 *
2759 * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
2760 * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
2761 */
2762
2763 /**
2764 * DOC: Beacon filter support
2765 *
2766 * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
2767 * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
2768 * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
2769 * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
2770 * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
2771 * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
2772 * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
2773 *
2774 * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
2775 * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
2776 * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
2777 * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
2778 * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
2779 *
2780 * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
2781 * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
2782 * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
2783 * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
2784 *
2785 * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
2786 * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
2787 * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
2788 * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
2789 *
2790 * - a list of information element IDs
2791 * - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
2792 *
2793 * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
2794 * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
2795 * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
2796 * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
2797 * vendor information elements.
2798 *
2799 * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
2800 * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
2801 *
2802 * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead, just make sure nothing
2803 * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
2804 * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
2805 * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
2806 * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
2807 * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
2808 *
2809 *
2810 * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
2811 * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
2812 * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
2813 * the received data packets). This can consist in notifying the host when
2814 * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
2815 * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
2816 * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
2817 * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
2818 *
2819 * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
2820 * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
2821 * signal strength threshold checking.
2822 */
2823
2824 /**
2825 * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
2826 *
2827 * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
2828 * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
2829 * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
2830 * "11.2.3 SM power save".
2831 *
2832 * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
2833 * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
2834 * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
2835 * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
2836 * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
2837 * hardware flags.
2838 *
2839 * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
2840 * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
2841 * turned off otherwise.
2842 *
2843 * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
2844 * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
2845 * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
2846 * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
2847 */
2848
2849 /**
2850 * DOC: Frame filtering
2851 *
2852 * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
2853 * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
2854 * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
2855 * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
2856 * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
2857 *
2858 * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
2859 * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
2860 * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
2861 *
2862 * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
2863 * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
2864 * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
2865 * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
2866 * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
2867 * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
2868 * @total_flags with the new flag states.
2869 *
2870 * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
2871 * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
2872 * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
2873 * or dropped.
2874 *
2875 * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
2876 * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
2877 * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
2878 * the flag, but not clear it.
2879 * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
2880 * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
2881 * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
2882 * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
2883 * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
2884 * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
2885 * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
2886 * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
2887 */
2888
2889 /**
2890 * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
2891 *
2892 * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
2893 * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
2894 * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
2895 *
2896 * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
2897 * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
2898 * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
2899 * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
2900 * the driver code.
2901 *
2902 * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
2903 * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
2904 * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
2905 * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
2906 * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
2907 * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
2908 * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
2909 *
2910 * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
2911 * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
2912 * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
2913 * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
2914 * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
2915 * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
2916 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
2917 * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
2918 * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
2919 * @sta_notify callback.
2920 *
2921 * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
2922 * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
2923 * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
2924 * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
2925 * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
2926 * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
2927 * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
2928 * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
2929 * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
2930 * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
2931 * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
2932 * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
2933 * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
2934 * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
2935 *
2936 * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
2937 * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
2938 *
2939 * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
2940 * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
2941 * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
2942 * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
2943 * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
2944 * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
2945 * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
2946 * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
2947 * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
2948 * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
2949 * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
2950 *
2951 * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
2952 * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
2953 * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
2954 * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
2955 * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
2956 * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
2957 * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
2958 * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
2959 * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
2960 * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames,
2961 * to help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
2962 * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
2963 * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
2964 * buffers for those TIDs contain.
2965 *
2966 * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
2967 * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
2968 * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
2969 * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
2970 * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
2971 * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
2972 * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
2973 *
2974 * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
2975 * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
2976 * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
2977 * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
2978 * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
2979 *
2980 * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
2981 * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
2982 * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
2983 * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
2984 */
2985
2986 /**
2987 * DOC: HW queue control
2988 *
2989 * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
2990 * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
2991 * was problematic for a few reasons:
2992 * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
2993 * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
2994 * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
2995 *
2996 * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
2997 * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
2998 * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
2999 *
3000 * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3001 * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3002 * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3003 * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3004 * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3005 * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3006 * the hardware queue.
3007 * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3008 * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3009 *
3010 * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed, multiple virtual
3011 * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3012 * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3013 * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3014 * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3015 *
3016 * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3017 * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3018 * after-DTIM queue for AP: 8
3019 * off-channel queue: 9
3020 *
3021 * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3022 * hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3023 *
3024 * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3025 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3026 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3027 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3028 * vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3029 * vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3030 * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3031 *
3032 * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3033 * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3034 *
3035 * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3036 * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3037 * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3038 * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3039 */
3040
3041 /**
3042 * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3043 *
3044 * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3045 * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3046 * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3047 * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3048 *
3049 * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3050 * by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3051 * multicast address.
3052 *
3053 * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3054 * %RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3055 *
3056 * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3057 * the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3058 *
3059 * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3060 * to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3061 * by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3062 * mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3063 * honour this flag if possible.
3064 *
3065 * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3066 * station
3067 *
3068 * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3069 *
3070 * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3071 *
3072 * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3073 */
3074 enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3075 FIF_ALLMULTI = 1<<1,
3076 FIF_FCSFAIL = 1<<2,
3077 FIF_PLCPFAIL = 1<<3,
3078 FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC = 1<<4,
3079 FIF_CONTROL = 1<<5,
3080 FIF_OTHER_BSS = 1<<6,
3081 FIF_PSPOLL = 1<<7,
3082 FIF_PROBE_REQ = 1<<8,
3083 };
3084
3085 /**
3086 * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3087 *
3088 * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3089 * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3090 *
3091 * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3092 * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3093 * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3094 * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3095 *
3096 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3097 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3098 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation
3099 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3100 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3101 * queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3102 * driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3103 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3104 * called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3105 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3106 * session is gone and removes the station.
3107 * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3108 * but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3109 * now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3110 * should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3111 */
3112 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3113 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3114 IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3115 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3116 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3117 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3118 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3119 IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3120 };
3121
3122 /**
3123 * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3124 *
3125 * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3126 * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3127 * @tid: tid of the BA session
3128 * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3129 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3130 * actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3131 * @buf_size: reorder buffer size (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3132 * action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3133 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3134 * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3135 * valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3136 * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3137 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3138 */
3139 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3140 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3141 struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3142 u16 tid;
3143 u16 ssn;
3144 u16 buf_size;
3145 bool amsdu;
3146 u16 timeout;
3147 };
3148
3149 /**
3150 * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3151 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3152 * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3153 * frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3154 */
3155 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3156 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3157 IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3158 };
3159
3160 /**
3161 * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3162 *
3163 * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3164 * to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3165 * information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3166 * flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3167 * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3168 * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3169 * changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3170 * the peer.
3171 * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3172 * by the peer
3173 */
3174 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3175 IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED = BIT(0),
3176 IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED = BIT(1),
3177 IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED = BIT(2),
3178 IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED = BIT(3),
3179 };
3180
3181 /**
3182 * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3183 *
3184 * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3185 * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3186 * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vise versa).
3187 * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3188 * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3189 *
3190 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3191 * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3192 * for sending managment frames offchannel.
3193 */
3194 enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3195 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3196 IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3197 };
3198
3199 /**
3200 * enum ieee80211_reconfig_complete_type - reconfig type
3201 *
3202 * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3203 * reconfiguration type was completed.
3204 *
3205 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3206 * (also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3207 * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3208 * of wowlan configuration)
3209 */
3210 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3211 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3212 IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3213 };
3214
3215 /**
3216 * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3217 *
3218 * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3219 * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3220 * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3221 *
3222 * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3223 * skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3224 * The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3225 * configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3226 * preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3227 * Must be atomic.
3228 *
3229 * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3230 * is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3231 * frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3232 * Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3233 * or zero.
3234 * When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3235 * to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3236 * is added.
3237 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3238 *
3239 * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3240 * is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3241 * it must turn off frame reception.)
3242 * May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3243 * an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3244 * you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3245 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3246 *
3247 * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3248 * stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3249 * ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3250 * configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3251 * reconfigured at resume time.
3252 * The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3253 * wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3254 * supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3255 * must return 1 from this function.
3256 *
3257 * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3258 * now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3259 * functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3260 * to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3261 * will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3262 *
3263 * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3264 * modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3265 * supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3266 * in suspend().
3267 *
3268 * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3269 * enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3270 * and @stop must be implemented.
3271 * The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3272 * the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3273 * interface is given in the conf parameter.
3274 * The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3275 * negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3276 * Must be implemented and can sleep.
3277 *
3278 * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3279 * is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3280 * switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3281 * Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3282 * found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3283 *
3284 * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3285 * The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3286 * and no monitor interfaces are present.
3287 * When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3288 * must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3289 * the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3290 * MAC address of the device going away.
3291 * Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3292 *
3293 * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3294 * function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3295 * This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3296 * if it does. The callback can sleep.
3297 *
3298 * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3299 * parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3300 * level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3301 * This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3302 * for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3303 * of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3304 * can sleep.
3305 *
3306 * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3307 * This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3308 * to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3309 *
3310 * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3311 * See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3312 * This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3313 *
3314 * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3315 * This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3316 * should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3317 * of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3318 * which flags are changed.
3319 * This callback can sleep.
3320 *
3321 * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3322 * must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3323 *
3324 * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3325 * This callback is only called between add_interface and
3326 * remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3327 * is enabled.
3328 * Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3329 * The callback can sleep.
3330 *
3331 * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3332 * This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3333 * which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3334 * The callback must be atomic.
3335 *
3336 * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3337 * host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3338 * necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3339 * After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3340 * userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3341 *
3342 * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3343 * WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3344 * offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3345 *
3346 * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3347 * the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3348 * configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3349 * registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3350 * that power save is disabled.
3351 * The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3352 * entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3353 * at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3354 * (extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3355 * When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3356 * note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3357 * any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
3358 * This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
3359 * this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
3360 * software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
3361 * capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
3362 * advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
3363 * The callback can sleep.
3364 *
3365 * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
3366 * The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
3367 * but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
3368 * ieee80211_scan_completed().
3369 * This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
3370 * scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
3371 * The callback can sleep.
3372 *
3373 * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
3374 * specific intervals. The driver must call the
3375 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
3376 * This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
3377 *
3378 * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
3379 * In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
3380 *
3381 * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
3382 * is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
3383 * The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
3384 * the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
3385 * can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
3386 *
3387 * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
3388 * software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
3389 * this notification.
3390 * The callback can sleep.
3391 *
3392 * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
3393 * Returns zero if statistics are available.
3394 * The callback can sleep.
3395 *
3396 * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
3397 * IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
3398 * IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
3399 * The callback must be atomic.
3400 *
3401 * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
3402 * if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
3403 * stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
3404 * should be set as well.
3405 * The callback can sleep.
3406 *
3407 * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
3408 * The callback can sleep.
3409 *
3410 * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
3411 * AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
3412 *
3413 * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
3414 * station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
3415 * returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
3416 * no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
3417 * the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3418 * This callback can sleep.
3419 *
3420 * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3421 * when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
3422 * should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3423 * callback can sleep.
3424 *
3425 * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
3426 * associated station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
3427 * in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
3428 * %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
3429 *
3430 * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
3431 * station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
3432 * This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
3433 * It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
3434 * up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
3435 * isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
3436 * period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
3437 * See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3438 * The callback can sleep.
3439 *
3440 * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
3441 * synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
3442 * pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
3443 * the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
3444 * in @sta_state.
3445 * The callback can sleep.
3446 *
3447 * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be
3448 * used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
3449 * from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
3450 * in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
3451 * uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
3452 * otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
3453 * Must be atomic.
3454 * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
3455 * is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
3456 * the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
3457 *
3458 * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
3459 * filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
3460 * let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
3461 * the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
3462 * all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
3463 * Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
3464 * The callback can sleep.
3465 *
3466 * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
3467 * bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
3468 * Returns a negative error code on failure.
3469 * The callback can sleep.
3470 *
3471 * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
3472 * this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
3473 * required function.
3474 * The callback can sleep.
3475 *
3476 * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
3477 * Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
3478 * required function.
3479 * The callback can sleep.
3480 *
3481 * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
3482 * firmware/hardware. Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
3483 * calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
3484 * as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
3485 * The callback can sleep.
3486 *
3487 * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
3488 * with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
3489 * function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
3490 * TSF synchronization.
3491 * The callback can sleep.
3492 *
3493 * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
3494 * This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
3495 * used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
3496 * Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
3497 * The callback can sleep.
3498 *
3499 * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
3500 *
3501 * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
3502 * need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
3503 * and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
3504 * The callback can sleep.
3505 *
3506 * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
3507 * in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
3508 * accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
3509 * estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
3510 * coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
3511 *
3512 * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
3513 * be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
3514 * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
3515 *
3516 * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
3517 * that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
3518 * of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
3519 * use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
3520 * If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
3521 * Note that vif can be NULL.
3522 * The callback can sleep.
3523 *
3524 * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
3525 * switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
3526 * callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
3527 * completion of the channel switch.
3528 *
3529 * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
3530 * Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
3531 * reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
3532 * (also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
3533 *
3534 * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
3535 *
3536 * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
3537 * call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
3538 * that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
3539 * offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
3540 * normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
3541 * duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
3542 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
3543 * Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
3544 * must be accepted in this case.
3545 * This callback may sleep.
3546 * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
3547 * aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
3548 *
3549 * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
3550 *
3551 * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
3552 *
3553 * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
3554 * queues before entering power save.
3555 *
3556 * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
3557 * when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
3558 * The callback can sleep.
3559 * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
3560 * &enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
3561 * The callback must be atomic.
3562 *
3563 * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
3564 * parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
3565 * sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
3566 * to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
3567 * Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
3568 * if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
3569 * the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
3570 * the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
3571 * more-data bit must always be set.
3572 * The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
3573 * from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
3574 * In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
3575 * @num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
3576 * this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
3577 * on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
3578 * period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
3579 * responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
3580 * In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
3581 * bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
3582 * at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
3583 * setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
3584 * service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
3585 * on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
3586 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
3587 * This callback must be atomic.
3588 * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
3589 * to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
3590 * via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
3591 * released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
3592 * and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
3593 * frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
3594 * them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
3595 * on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
3596 * bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
3597 * ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
3598 * The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
3599 * frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
3600 * This callback must be atomic.
3601 *
3602 * @get_et_sset_count: Ethtool API to get string-set count.
3603 *
3604 * @get_et_stats: Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
3605 *
3606 * @get_et_strings: Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
3607 * and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
3608 *
3609 * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
3610 * before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
3611 * bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
3612 * yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
3613 * transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
3614 * powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
3615 * management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the
3616 * driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response
3617 * and to be able to synchronize with the GO.
3618 * For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211
3619 * would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication
3620 * frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO.
3621 * The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
3622 * mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
3623 * If duration is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the driver the
3624 * duration for which the operation is requested.
3625 * The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
3626 *
3627 * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
3628 * a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
3629 * channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
3630 * setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
3631 * mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
3632 * discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
3633 * 2 * (DTIM period).
3634 * The callback is optional and can sleep.
3635 *
3636 * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
3637 * This callback may sleep.
3638 * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
3639 * This callback may sleep.
3640 * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
3641 * may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
3642 * channel context with different settings
3643 * This callback may sleep.
3644 * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
3645 * to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
3646 * This callback may sleep.
3647 * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
3648 * unbound from vif.
3649 * This callback may sleep.
3650 * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
3651 * another, as specified in the list of
3652 * @ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
3653 * to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
3654 * This callback may sleep.
3655 *
3656 * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
3657 * information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
3658 * context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
3659 * software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
3660 * just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
3661 * disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
3662 * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
3663 *
3664 * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
3665 * during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
3666 * This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
3667 * indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
3668 * This callback may sleep.
3669 *
3670 * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
3671 * Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
3672 * This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
3673 *
3674 * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
3675 * Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
3676 * function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
3677 * decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
3678 * ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
3679 * get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
3680 * 1 using ieee80211_csa_is_complete() after the beacon has been
3681 * transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
3682 * If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
3683 * since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
3684 * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
3685 * before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
3686 * gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
3687 * the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
3688 * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
3689 * after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
3690 * driver to go back to a normal configuration.
3691 * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
3692 * when channel switch procedure was completed, allowing the
3693 * driver to go back to a normal configuration.
3694 * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
3695 * when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
3696 * CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
3697 * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
3698 * information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
3699 * channel context is bound before this is called.
3700 * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
3701 *
3702 * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
3703 * specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
3704 * if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
3705 *
3706 * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
3707 * and hardware limits.
3708 *
3709 * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
3710 * is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
3711 * and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
3712 * driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
3713 * the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
3714 * The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
3715 * optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
3716 * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
3717 * peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
3718 * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
3719 * response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
3720 * parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
3721 * an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
3722 * response template is provided, together with the location of the
3723 * switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
3724 * the function call.
3725 *
3726 * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
3727 * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
3728 * synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
3729 * pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
3730 * currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
3731 *
3732 * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
3733 * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
3734 * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
3735 * contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
3736 * are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
3737 * The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
3738 * some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
3739 * changed parameters.
3740 * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
3741 * cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
3742 * this call.
3743 * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
3744 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
3745 * NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
3746 * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
3747 * aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
3748 * between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
3749 * skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
3750 * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
3751 * Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
3752 *
3753 * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
3754 * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
3755 */
3756 struct ieee80211_ops {
3757 void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3758 struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
3759 struct sk_buff *skb);
3760 int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3761 void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3762 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
3763 int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
3764 int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3765 void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
3766 #endif
3767 int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3768 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3769 int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3770 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3771 enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
3772 void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3773 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3774 int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
3775 void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3776 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3777 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
3778 u32 changed);
3779
3780 int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3781 void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3782
3783 u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3784 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
3785 void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3786 unsigned int changed_flags,
3787 unsigned int *total_flags,
3788 u64 multicast);
3789 void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3790 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3791 unsigned int filter_flags,
3792 unsigned int changed_flags);
3793 int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3794 bool set);
3795 int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
3796 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3797 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
3798 void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3799 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3800 struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
3801 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3802 u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
3803 void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3804 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3805 struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
3806 void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3807 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
3808 int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3809 struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
3810 void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3811 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3812 int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3813 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3814 struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
3815 struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
3816 int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3817 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3818 void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3819 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3820 const u8 *mac_addr);
3821 void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3822 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3823 int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3824 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
3825 void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3826 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
3827 struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
3828 int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
3829 int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
3830 int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3831 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
3832 int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3833 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
3834 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
3835 void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3836 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3837 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3838 struct dentry *dir);
3839 #endif
3840 void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3841 enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
3842 int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3843 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3844 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
3845 int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3846 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3847 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
3848 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
3849 void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3850 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3851 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
3852 void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3853 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3854 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3855 u32 changed);
3856 void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3857 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3858 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
3859 void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3860 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3861 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3862 struct station_info *sinfo);
3863 int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3864 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ac,
3865 const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
3866 u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3867 void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3868 u64 tsf);
3869 void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3870 s64 offset);
3871 void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3872 int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3873
3874 /**
3875 * @ampdu_action:
3876 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
3877 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
3878 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
3879 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3880 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
3881 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
3882 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
3883 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
3884 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
3885 *
3886 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
3887 * - ``RX: 2....7`` (lost frame #1)
3888 * - ``TX: 8..1...``
3889 *
3890 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
3891 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
3892 *
3893 * - ``TX: 1 or``
3894 * - ``TX: 18 or``
3895 * - ``TX: 81``
3896 *
3897 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
3898 *
3899 * Returns a negative error code on failure.
3900 * The callback can sleep.
3901 */
3902 int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3903 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3904 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
3905 int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
3906 struct survey_info *survey);
3907 void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3908 void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
3909 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
3910 int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3911 void *data, int len);
3912 int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
3913 struct netlink_callback *cb,
3914 void *data, int len);
3915 #endif
3916 void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3917 u32 queues, bool drop);
3918 void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3919 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3920 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
3921 int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
3922 int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
3923
3924 int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3925 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3926 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
3927 int duration,
3928 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
3929 int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3930 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3931 int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
3932 void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3933 u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
3934 bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
3935 int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3936 const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
3937 void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3938 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3939 const struct ieee80211_event *event);
3940
3941 void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3942 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3943 u16 tids, int num_frames,
3944 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
3945 bool more_data);
3946 void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3947 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
3948 u16 tids, int num_frames,
3949 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
3950 bool more_data);
3951
3952 int (*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3953 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
3954 void (*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3955 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3956 struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
3957 void (*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3958 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3959 u32 sset, u8 *data);
3960
3961 void (*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3962 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3963 u16 duration);
3964
3965 void (*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3966 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
3967
3968 int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3969 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
3970 void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3971 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
3972 void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3973 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
3974 u32 changed);
3975 int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3976 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3977 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
3978 void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3979 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3980 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
3981 int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3982 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
3983 int n_vifs,
3984 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
3985
3986 void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3987 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
3988
3989 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
3990 void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3991 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3992 struct inet6_dev *idev);
3993 #endif
3994 void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3995 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3996 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
3997 int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3998 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
3999 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4000
4001 int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4002 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4003 void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4004 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4005 void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4006 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4007 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4008
4009 int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4010 void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4011 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4012 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4013 int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4014 int *dbm);
4015
4016 int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4017 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4018 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4019 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4020 struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4021 void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4022 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4023 struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4024 void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4025 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4026 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4027
4028 void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4029 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4030 void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4031
4032 int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4033 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4034 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4035 int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4036 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4037 int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4038 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4039 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4040 int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4041 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4042 const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4043 void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4044 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4045 u8 instance_id);
4046 bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4047 struct sk_buff *head,
4048 struct sk_buff *skb);
4049 int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4050 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4051 struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4052 int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4053 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4054 void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4055 struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4056 };
4057
4058 /**
4059 * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4060 *
4061 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4062 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4063 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4064 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4065 * @priv_data_len.
4066 *
4067 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4068 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4069 * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4070 * NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4071 *
4072 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4073 */
4074 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4075 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4076 const char *requested_name);
4077
4078 /**
4079 * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4080 *
4081 * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4082 * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4083 * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4084 * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4085 * @priv_data_len.
4086 *
4087 * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4088 * @ops: callbacks for this device
4089 *
4090 * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4091 */
4092 static inline
ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,const struct ieee80211_ops * ops)4093 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4094 const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4095 {
4096 return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4097 }
4098
4099 /**
4100 * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4101 *
4102 * You must call this function before any other functions in
4103 * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4104 * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4105 *
4106 * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4107 *
4108 * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4109 */
4110 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4111
4112 /**
4113 * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4114 * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4115 * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4116 * (full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4117 */
4118 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4119 int throughput;
4120 int blink_time;
4121 };
4122
4123 /**
4124 * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4125 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4126 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4127 * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4128 * interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4129 */
4130 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4131 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO = BIT(0),
4132 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK = BIT(1),
4133 IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED = BIT(2),
4134 };
4135
4136 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4137 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4138 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4139 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4140 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4141 const char *
4142 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4143 unsigned int flags,
4144 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4145 unsigned int blink_table_len);
4146 #endif
4147 /**
4148 * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4149 *
4150 * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4151 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4152 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4153 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4154 *
4155 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4156 *
4157 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4158 */
ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4159 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4160 {
4161 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4162 return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
4163 #else
4164 return NULL;
4165 #endif
4166 }
4167
4168 /**
4169 * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
4170 *
4171 * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4172 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4173 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4174 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4175 *
4176 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4177 *
4178 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4179 */
ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4180 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4181 {
4182 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4183 return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
4184 #else
4185 return NULL;
4186 #endif
4187 }
4188
4189 /**
4190 * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
4191 *
4192 * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4193 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4194 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4195 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4196 *
4197 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4198 *
4199 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4200 */
ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4201 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4202 {
4203 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4204 return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
4205 #else
4206 return NULL;
4207 #endif
4208 }
4209
4210 /**
4211 * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
4212 *
4213 * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4214 * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4215 * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4216 * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4217 *
4218 * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4219 *
4220 * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4221 */
ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw * hw)4222 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4223 {
4224 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4225 return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
4226 #else
4227 return NULL;
4228 #endif
4229 }
4230
4231 /**
4232 * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
4233 * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
4234 * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
4235 * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
4236 * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
4237 *
4238 * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
4239 * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
4240 *
4241 * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
4242 */
4243 static inline const char *
ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,unsigned int flags,const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink * blink_table,unsigned int blink_table_len)4244 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
4245 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4246 unsigned int blink_table_len)
4247 {
4248 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4249 return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
4250 blink_table_len);
4251 #else
4252 return NULL;
4253 #endif
4254 }
4255
4256 /**
4257 * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
4258 *
4259 * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
4260 * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
4261 *
4262 * @hw: the hardware to unregister
4263 */
4264 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4265
4266 /**
4267 * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
4268 *
4269 * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
4270 * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
4271 * before calling this function.
4272 *
4273 * @hw: the hardware to free
4274 */
4275 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4276
4277 /**
4278 * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
4279 *
4280 * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
4281 * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
4282 * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
4283 * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
4284 * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
4285 * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
4286 *
4287 * @hw: the hardware to restart
4288 */
4289 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4290
4291 /**
4292 * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
4293 *
4294 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4295 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4296 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4297 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4298 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4299 *
4300 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4301 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4302 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4303 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4304 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4305 *
4306 * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
4307 *
4308 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4309 * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4310 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4311 * @napi: the NAPI context
4312 */
4313 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4314 struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
4315
4316 /**
4317 * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
4318 *
4319 * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4320 * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4321 * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4322 * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4323 * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4324 *
4325 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4326 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4327 * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4328 * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4329 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4330 *
4331 * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
4332 *
4333 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4334 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4335 */
ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)4336 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
4337 {
4338 ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
4339 }
4340
4341 /**
4342 * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
4343 *
4344 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
4345 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
4346 *
4347 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
4348 * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
4349 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4350 *
4351 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4352 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4353 */
4354 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
4355
4356 /**
4357 * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
4358 *
4359 * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
4360 * (internally disables bottom halves).
4361 *
4362 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
4363 * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4364 * ieee80211_tx_status() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4365 *
4366 * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4367 * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4368 */
ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)4369 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4370 struct sk_buff *skb)
4371 {
4372 local_bh_disable();
4373 ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
4374 local_bh_enable();
4375 }
4376
4377 /**
4378 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
4379 *
4380 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
4381 * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
4382 * entering/leaving PS mode.
4383 *
4384 * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
4385 *
4386 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
4387 * each other.
4388 *
4389 * @sta: currently connected sta
4390 * @start: start or stop PS
4391 *
4392 * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
4393 */
4394 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
4395
4396 /**
4397 * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
4398 * (in process context)
4399 *
4400 * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
4401 * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
4402 * applies.
4403 *
4404 * @sta: currently connected sta
4405 * @start: start or stop PS
4406 *
4407 * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
4408 */
ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,bool start)4409 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4410 bool start)
4411 {
4412 int ret;
4413
4414 local_bh_disable();
4415 ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
4416 local_bh_enable();
4417
4418 return ret;
4419 }
4420
4421 /**
4422 * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
4423 * @sta: currently connected station
4424 *
4425 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
4426 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
4427 * connected station was received.
4428 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
4429 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
4430 * be serialized.
4431 */
4432 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4433
4434 /**
4435 * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
4436 * @sta: currently connected station
4437 * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
4438 *
4439 * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
4440 * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
4441 * from a connected station was received.
4442 * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
4443 * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
4444 * serialized.
4445 * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
4446 * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
4447 * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
4448 * checks.
4449 */
4450 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
4451
4452 /*
4453 * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
4454 * This is enough for the radiotap header.
4455 */
4456 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM ALIGN(14, 4)
4457
4458 /**
4459 * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
4460 * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
4461 * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
4462 * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
4463 *
4464 * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
4465 * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
4466 * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
4467 *
4468 * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
4469 * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
4470 * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
4471 * call! Beware of the locking!)
4472 *
4473 * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
4474 * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
4475 * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
4476 * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
4477 * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
4478 * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
4479 *
4480 * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
4481 * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
4482 * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
4483 * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
4484 * use this API.
4485 */
4486 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4487 u8 tid, bool buffered);
4488
4489 /**
4490 * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
4491 *
4492 * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
4493 * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
4494 * rate selection table for the station entry.
4495 *
4496 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4497 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
4498 * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
4499 * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
4500 * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
4501 */
4502 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4503 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4504 struct sk_buff *skb,
4505 struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
4506 int max_rates);
4507
4508 /**
4509 * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station
4510 *
4511 * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput
4512 * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can
4513 * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station
4514 * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic
4515 * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause
4516 * slow stations to starve).
4517 *
4518 * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for.
4519 * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps.
4520 */
4521 void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
4522 u32 thr);
4523
4524 /**
4525 * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
4526 *
4527 * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
4528 * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
4529 * in updating the tx rate in data path.
4530 *
4531 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4532 * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
4533 * @info: tx status information
4534 */
4535 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4536 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
4537 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
4538
4539 /**
4540 * ieee80211_tx_status - transmit status callback
4541 *
4542 * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
4543 * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
4544 * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
4545 *
4546 * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4547 * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
4548 * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
4549 * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4550 * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
4551 *
4552 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4553 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
4554 */
4555 void ieee80211_tx_status(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4556 struct sk_buff *skb);
4557
4558 /**
4559 * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
4560 *
4561 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
4562 * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
4563 * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
4564 *
4565 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
4566 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
4567 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
4568 *
4569 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4570 * @status: tx status information
4571 */
4572 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4573 struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
4574
4575 /**
4576 * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
4577 *
4578 * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status
4579 * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
4580 * specific skbs.
4581 *
4582 * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
4583 * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
4584 * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
4585 *
4586 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4587 * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
4588 * (NULL for multicast packets)
4589 * @info: tx status information
4590 */
ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_sta * sta,struct ieee80211_tx_info * info)4591 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4592 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4593 struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
4594 {
4595 struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
4596 .sta = sta,
4597 .info = info,
4598 };
4599
4600 ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
4601 }
4602
4603 /**
4604 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
4605 *
4606 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in process context.
4607 *
4608 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
4609 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
4610 * for a single hardware.
4611 *
4612 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4613 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
4614 */
ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct sk_buff * skb)4615 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4616 struct sk_buff *skb)
4617 {
4618 local_bh_disable();
4619 ieee80211_tx_status(hw, skb);
4620 local_bh_enable();
4621 }
4622
4623 /**
4624 * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
4625 *
4626 * Like ieee80211_tx_status() but can be called in IRQ context
4627 * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
4628 *
4629 * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status() and
4630 * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
4631 *
4632 * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
4633 * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
4634 */
4635 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4636 struct sk_buff *skb);
4637
4638 /**
4639 * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
4640 *
4641 * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
4642 * connected STA.
4643 *
4644 * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
4645 * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
4646 */
4647 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
4648
4649 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS_NUM 2
4650
4651 /**
4652 * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
4653 * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
4654 * @tim_length: size of TIM element
4655 * @csa_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
4656 * to CSA counters. This array can contain zero values which
4657 * should be ignored.
4658 */
4659 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
4660 u16 tim_offset;
4661 u16 tim_length;
4662
4663 u16 csa_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CSA_COUNTERS_NUM];
4664 };
4665
4666 /**
4667 * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
4668 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4669 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4670 * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
4671 * receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
4672 *
4673 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
4674 * obtain the beacon template.
4675 *
4676 * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
4677 * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
4678 * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
4679 * applicable, the CSA count.
4680 *
4681 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
4682 *
4683 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
4684 */
4685 struct sk_buff *
4686 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4687 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4688 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs);
4689
4690 /**
4691 * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
4692 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4693 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4694 * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
4695 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
4696 * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
4697 * (including the ID and length bytes!).
4698 * Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
4699 *
4700 * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
4701 * obtain the beacon frame.
4702 *
4703 * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
4704 * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
4705 * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
4706 * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
4707 *
4708 * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
4709 *
4710 * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
4711 */
4712 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4713 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4714 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length);
4715
4716 /**
4717 * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
4718 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4719 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4720 *
4721 * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
4722 *
4723 * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
4724 */
ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_vif * vif)4725 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4726 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
4727 {
4728 return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL);
4729 }
4730
4731 /**
4732 * ieee80211_csa_update_counter - request mac80211 to decrement the csa counter
4733 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4734 *
4735 * The csa counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
4736 * This function is called implicitly when
4737 * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
4738 * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
4739 * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's csa counters.
4740 *
4741 * Return: new csa counter value
4742 */
4743 u8 ieee80211_csa_update_counter(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4744
4745 /**
4746 * ieee80211_csa_set_counter - request mac80211 to set csa counter
4747 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4748 * @counter: the new value for the counter
4749 *
4750 * The csa counter can be changed by the device, this API should be
4751 * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
4752 *
4753 * It should never be used together with ieee80211_csa_update_counter(),
4754 * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
4755 */
4756 void ieee80211_csa_set_counter(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
4757
4758 /**
4759 * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
4760 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4761 *
4762 * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
4763 * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
4764 * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
4765 */
4766 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4767
4768 /**
4769 * ieee80211_csa_is_complete - find out if counters reached 1
4770 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4771 *
4772 * This function returns whether the channel switch counters reached zero.
4773 */
4774 bool ieee80211_csa_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4775
4776
4777 /**
4778 * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
4779 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4780 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4781 *
4782 * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
4783 * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
4784 *
4785 * Can only be called in AP mode.
4786 *
4787 * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
4788 */
4789 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4790 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4791
4792 /**
4793 * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
4794 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4795 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4796 *
4797 * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
4798 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
4799 * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
4800 *
4801 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
4802 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
4803 *
4804 * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
4805 */
4806 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4807 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4808
4809 /**
4810 * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
4811 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4812 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4813 * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
4814 * if at all possible
4815 *
4816 * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
4817 * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
4818 * BSSID and address is used.
4819 *
4820 * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
4821 * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
4822 *
4823 * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
4824 * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
4825 *
4826 * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
4827 */
4828 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4829 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4830 bool qos_ok);
4831
4832 /**
4833 * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
4834 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4835 * @src_addr: source MAC address
4836 * @ssid: SSID buffer
4837 * @ssid_len: length of SSID
4838 * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
4839 *
4840 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
4841 * hardware.
4842 *
4843 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
4844 */
4845 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4846 const u8 *src_addr,
4847 const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
4848 size_t tailroom);
4849
4850 /**
4851 * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
4852 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4853 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4854 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
4855 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
4856 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
4857 * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
4858 *
4859 * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
4860 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
4861 * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
4862 * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
4863 */
4864 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4865 const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
4866 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
4867 struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
4868
4869 /**
4870 * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
4871 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4872 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4873 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
4874 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
4875 *
4876 * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
4877 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
4878 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
4879 *
4880 * Return: The duration.
4881 */
4882 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4883 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
4884 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
4885
4886 /**
4887 * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
4888 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4889 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4890 * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
4891 * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
4892 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
4893 * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
4894 *
4895 * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
4896 * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
4897 * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
4898 * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
4899 */
4900 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4901 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4902 const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
4903 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
4904 struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
4905
4906 /**
4907 * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
4908 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4909 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4910 * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
4911 * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
4912 *
4913 * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
4914 * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
4915 * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
4916 *
4917 * Return: The duration.
4918 */
4919 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4920 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4921 size_t frame_len,
4922 const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
4923
4924 /**
4925 * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
4926 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4927 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4928 * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
4929 * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
4930 * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
4931 *
4932 * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
4933 * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
4934 *
4935 * Return: The duration.
4936 */
4937 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4938 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4939 enum nl80211_band band,
4940 size_t frame_len,
4941 struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
4942
4943 /**
4944 * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
4945 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
4946 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
4947 *
4948 * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
4949 * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
4950 * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
4951 * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
4952 * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
4953 *
4954 * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
4955 * frames are available.
4956 *
4957 * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
4958 * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
4959 * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
4960 * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
4961 * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
4962 * use common code for all beacons.
4963 */
4964 struct sk_buff *
4965 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4966
4967 /**
4968 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
4969 *
4970 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
4971 *
4972 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
4973 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
4974 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
4975 */
4976 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
4977 u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
4978
4979 /**
4980 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
4981 *
4982 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
4983 * from the given packet.
4984 *
4985 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
4986 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
4987 * with this P1K
4988 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
4989 */
ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf * keyconf,struct sk_buff * skb,u16 * p1k)4990 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
4991 struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
4992 {
4993 struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
4994 const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
4995 u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
4996
4997 ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
4998 }
4999
5000 /**
5001 * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5002 *
5003 * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5004 * and transmitter address.
5005 *
5006 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5007 * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5008 * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5009 * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5010 */
5011 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5012 const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5013
5014 /**
5015 * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5016 *
5017 * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5018 * in the packet.
5019 *
5020 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5021 * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5022 * encrypted with this key
5023 * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5024 */
5025 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5026 struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5027
5028 /**
5029 * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5030 *
5031 * @pos: start of crypto header
5032 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5033 * @pn: PN to add
5034 *
5035 * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5036 * the packet payload)
5037 *
5038 * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5039 * point to the crypto header)
5040 */
5041 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5042
5043 /**
5044 * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5045 *
5046 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5047 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5048 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5049 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5050 * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
5051 *
5052 * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
5053 * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
5054 * by the device and not by mac80211.
5055 *
5056 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5057 * can be done concurrently.
5058 */
5059 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5060 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5061
5062 /**
5063 * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
5064 *
5065 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5066 * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5067 * the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5068 * CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5069 * @seq: new sequence data
5070 *
5071 * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
5072 * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
5073 * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
5074 * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
5075 *
5076 * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5077 * can be done concurrently.
5078 */
5079 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5080 int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5081
5082 /**
5083 * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
5084 * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5085 *
5086 * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
5087 * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
5088 * instead assumed to have been removed already.
5089 *
5090 * Note that due to locking considerations this function can (currently)
5091 * only be called during key iteration (ieee80211_iter_keys().)
5092 */
5093 void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5094
5095 /**
5096 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
5097 * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
5098 * @keyconf: new key data
5099 *
5100 * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
5101 * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
5102 * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
5103 *
5104 * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will
5105 * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
5106 * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
5107 * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
5108 *
5109 * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
5110 * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
5111 * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
5112 * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
5113 * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
5114 * of the reconfiguration.
5115 *
5116 * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
5117 * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
5118 *
5119 * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
5120 * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
5121 * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
5122 * the key that's being replaced.
5123 */
5124 struct ieee80211_key_conf *
5125 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5126 struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5127
5128 /**
5129 * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
5130 * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
5131 * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
5132 * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
5133 * @gfp: allocation flags
5134 */
5135 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
5136 const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
5137
5138 /**
5139 * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
5140 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5141 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5142 *
5143 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
5144 */
5145 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5146
5147 /**
5148 * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
5149 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5150 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5151 *
5152 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5153 */
5154 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5155
5156 /**
5157 * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
5158 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5159 * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5160 *
5161 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5162 *
5163 * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
5164 */
5165
5166 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5167
5168 /**
5169 * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
5170 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5171 *
5172 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5173 */
5174 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5175
5176 /**
5177 * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
5178 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5179 *
5180 * Drivers should use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
5181 */
5182 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5183
5184 /**
5185 * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
5186 *
5187 * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
5188 * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
5189 * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
5190 * any context, including hardirq context.
5191 *
5192 * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
5193 * @info: information about the completed scan
5194 */
5195 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5196 struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
5197
5198 /**
5199 * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
5200 *
5201 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
5202 * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
5203 *
5204 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5205 */
5206 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5207
5208 /**
5209 * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
5210 *
5211 * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
5212 * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
5213 * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
5214 * while associating, for instance.
5215 *
5216 * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
5217 */
5218 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5219
5220 /**
5221 * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
5222 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
5223 * been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
5224 * reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
5225 * interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
5226 * haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5227 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
5228 * interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
5229 * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
5230 */
5231 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
5232 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL = 0,
5233 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL = BIT(0),
5234 IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE = BIT(1),
5235 };
5236
5237 /**
5238 * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
5239 *
5240 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5241 * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
5242 * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
5243 * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5244 *
5245 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5246 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5247 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5248 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5249 */
5250 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5251 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5252 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5253 void *data);
5254
5255 /**
5256 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
5257 *
5258 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5259 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5260 * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
5261 * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
5262 * be used.
5263 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5264 *
5265 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5266 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5267 * @iterator: the iterator function to call
5268 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5269 */
5270 static inline void
ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u32 iter_flags,void (* iterator)(void * data,u8 * mac,struct ieee80211_vif * vif),void * data)5271 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
5272 void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
5273 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5274 void *data)
5275 {
5276 ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
5277 iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
5278 iterator, data);
5279 }
5280
5281 /**
5282 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
5283 *
5284 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5285 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5286 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
5287 * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
5288 * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
5289 *
5290 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5291 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5292 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5293 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5294 */
5295 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5296 u32 iter_flags,
5297 void (*iterator)(void *data,
5298 u8 *mac,
5299 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5300 void *data);
5301
5302 /**
5303 * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_rtnl - iterate active interfaces
5304 *
5305 * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
5306 * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
5307 * This version can only be used while holding the RTNL.
5308 *
5309 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5310 * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
5311 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5312 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5313 */
5314 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_rtnl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5315 u32 iter_flags,
5316 void (*iterator)(void *data,
5317 u8 *mac,
5318 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
5319 void *data);
5320
5321 /**
5322 * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
5323 *
5324 * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
5325 * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
5326 * function for them.
5327 * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
5328 *
5329 * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
5330 * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
5331 * @data: first argument of the iterator function
5332 */
5333 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5334 void (*iterator)(void *data,
5335 struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
5336 void *data);
5337 /**
5338 * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
5339 *
5340 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
5341 * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
5342 *
5343 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
5344 * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
5345 */
5346 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
5347
5348 /**
5349 * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
5350 *
5351 * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
5352 * workqueue.
5353 *
5354 * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
5355 * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
5356 * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
5357 */
5358 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5359 struct delayed_work *dwork,
5360 unsigned long delay);
5361
5362 /**
5363 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
5364 * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
5365 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
5366 * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
5367 *
5368 * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
5369 *
5370 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
5371 * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
5372 * will be managed by the mac80211.
5373 */
5374 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
5375 u16 timeout);
5376
5377 /**
5378 * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
5379 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5380 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
5381 * @tid: the TID to BA on.
5382 *
5383 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
5384 * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
5385 * from any context.
5386 */
5387 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
5388 u16 tid);
5389
5390 /**
5391 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
5392 * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
5393 * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
5394 *
5395 * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
5396 *
5397 * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
5398 * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
5399 * will be managed by the mac80211.
5400 */
5401 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
5402
5403 /**
5404 * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
5405 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5406 * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
5407 * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
5408 *
5409 * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
5410 * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
5411 * can be called from any context.
5412 */
5413 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
5414 u16 tid);
5415
5416 /**
5417 * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
5418 *
5419 * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
5420 * @addr: station's address
5421 *
5422 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
5423 *
5424 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
5425 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
5426 */
5427 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5428 const u8 *addr);
5429
5430 /**
5431 * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
5432 *
5433 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5434 * @addr: remote station's address
5435 * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
5436 *
5437 * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
5438 *
5439 * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
5440 * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
5441 *
5442 * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
5443 * the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
5444 * We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
5445 * logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
5446 * BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
5447 * In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
5448 * is not reliable.
5449 *
5450 * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
5451 */
5452 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5453 const u8 *addr,
5454 const u8 *localaddr);
5455
5456 /**
5457 * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
5458 * @hw: the hardware
5459 * @pubsta: the station
5460 * @block: whether to block or unblock
5461 *
5462 * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
5463 * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
5464 * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
5465 * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
5466 * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
5467 *
5468 * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
5469 * manner.
5470 *
5471 * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
5472 * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
5473 * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
5474 * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
5475 * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
5476 * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
5477 * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
5478 * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
5479 * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
5480 * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
5481 * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
5482 * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
5483 * woke up while blocked or not.
5484 */
5485 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5486 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
5487
5488 /**
5489 * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
5490 * @pubsta: the station
5491 *
5492 * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
5493 * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
5494 * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
5495 * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
5496 *
5497 * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
5498 * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
5499 * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
5500 * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
5501 *
5502 * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
5503 * driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
5504 * you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
5505 * and restore the _irqsafe version!
5506 */
5507 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
5508
5509 /**
5510 * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
5511 * @pubsta: the station
5512 * @tid: the tid of the NDP
5513 *
5514 * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
5515 * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
5516 * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
5517 * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
5518 * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
5519 * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
5520 * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
5521 * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
5522 * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
5523 * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
5524 * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
5525 * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
5526 * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
5527 * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
5528 */
5529 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
5530
5531 /**
5532 * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
5533 *
5534 * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver can call
5535 * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
5536 * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
5537 * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
5538 *
5539 * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
5540 * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
5541 * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
5542 * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
5543 * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
5544 * attempts.
5545 *
5546 * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
5547 * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
5548 * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
5549 * them to 0.
5550 *
5551 * @pubsta: the station
5552 * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
5553 * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
5554 * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
5555 */
5556 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
5557 u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
5558
5559 /**
5560 * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
5561 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5562 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
5563 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
5564 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
5565 *
5566 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
5567 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
5568 * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
5569 * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend. Note that due
5570 * to locking reasons, it is also only safe to call this at few
5571 * spots since it must hold the RTNL and be able to sleep.
5572 *
5573 * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
5574 * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
5575 * set_key callback.
5576 */
5577 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5578 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5579 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5580 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5581 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5582 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
5583 void *data),
5584 void *iter_data);
5585
5586 /**
5587 * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
5588 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5589 * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
5590 * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
5591 * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
5592 *
5593 * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
5594 * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
5595 * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
5596 * in removal process will be skipped.
5597 *
5598 * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
5599 * and thus iter must be atomic.
5600 */
5601 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5602 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5603 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5604 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5605 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5606 struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
5607 void *data),
5608 void *iter_data);
5609
5610 /**
5611 * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
5612 * @hw: pointre obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5613 * @iter: iterator function
5614 * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
5615 *
5616 * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
5617 * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
5618 * places while calling into the driver.
5619 *
5620 * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
5621 * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
5622 * removed.
5623 *
5624 * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
5625 * before the restart are considered already present so will be
5626 * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
5627 * or not.
5628 */
5629 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
5630 struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5631 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5632 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
5633 void *data),
5634 void *iter_data);
5635
5636 /**
5637 * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5638 * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5639 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5640 *
5641 * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5642 * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
5643 * information. This function must only be called from within the
5644 * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
5645 * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
5646 * %NULL.
5647 *
5648 * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5649 */
5650 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5651 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5652
5653 /**
5654 * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
5655 *
5656 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5657 *
5658 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
5659 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
5660 * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
5661 */
5662 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5663
5664 /**
5665 * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
5666 *
5667 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5668 *
5669 * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
5670 * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
5671 * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
5672 * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
5673 * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
5674 *
5675 * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
5676 * without connection recovery attempts.
5677 */
5678 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5679
5680 /**
5681 * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
5682 *
5683 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5684 *
5685 * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
5686 * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
5687 * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
5688 * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
5689 * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
5690 *
5691 * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
5692 * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
5693 * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
5694 * disconnect normally later.
5695 *
5696 * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
5697 * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
5698 * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
5699 * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
5700 */
5701 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5702
5703 /**
5704 * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
5705 * rssi threshold triggered
5706 *
5707 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5708 * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
5709 * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
5710 * @gfp: context flags
5711 *
5712 * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
5713 * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
5714 * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
5715 */
5716 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5717 enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
5718 s32 rssi_level,
5719 gfp_t gfp);
5720
5721 /**
5722 * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
5723 *
5724 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5725 * @gfp: context flags
5726 */
5727 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
5728
5729 /**
5730 * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
5731 *
5732 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5733 */
5734 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5735
5736 /**
5737 * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
5738 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5739 * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
5740 *
5741 * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
5742 * and wake up the suspended queues.
5743 */
5744 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success);
5745
5746 /**
5747 * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
5748 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5749 * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
5750 *
5751 * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
5752 * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
5753 * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
5754 */
5755 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5756 enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
5757
5758 /**
5759 * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
5760 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5761 */
5762 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5763
5764 /**
5765 * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
5766 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5767 */
5768 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5769
5770 /**
5771 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
5772 *
5773 * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
5774 * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
5775 * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
5776 * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
5777 * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
5778 * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
5779 *
5780 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5781 * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
5782 * @addr: & to bssid mac address
5783 */
5784 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
5785 const u8 *addr);
5786
5787 /**
5788 * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
5789 * @pubsta: station struct
5790 * @tid: the session's TID
5791 * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
5792 * assumed to be out of the window after the call
5793 * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
5794 * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
5795 *
5796 * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
5797 * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
5798 * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
5799 * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
5800 */
5801 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
5802 u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
5803 u16 received_mpdus);
5804
5805 /**
5806 * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
5807 *
5808 * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
5809 * buffer.
5810 *
5811 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5812 * @ra: the peer's destination address
5813 * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
5814 * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
5815 */
5816 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
5817
5818 /**
5819 * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
5820 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5821 * @addr: station mac address
5822 * @tid: the rx tid
5823 */
5824 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
5825 unsigned int tid);
5826
5827 /**
5828 * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
5829 *
5830 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
5831 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
5832 * reordering.
5833 *
5834 * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
5835 * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
5836 *
5837 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5838 * @addr: station mac address
5839 * @tid: the rx tid
5840 */
ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)5841 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5842 const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
5843 {
5844 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
5845 return;
5846 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
5847 }
5848
5849 /**
5850 * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
5851 *
5852 * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
5853 * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
5854 * reordering.
5855 *
5856 * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
5857 * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
5858 *
5859 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5860 * @addr: station mac address
5861 * @tid: the rx tid
5862 */
ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif * vif,const u8 * addr,u16 tid)5863 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5864 const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
5865 {
5866 if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
5867 return;
5868 ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
5869 }
5870
5871 /**
5872 * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
5873 *
5874 * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
5875 * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
5876 *
5877 * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
5878 *
5879 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
5880 * @addr: station mac address
5881 * @tid: the rx tid
5882 */
5883 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5884 const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
5885
5886 /* Rate control API */
5887
5888 /**
5889 * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
5890 *
5891 * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
5892 * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
5893 * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
5894 * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
5895 * to be filled in
5896 * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
5897 * which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
5898 * used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
5899 * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
5900 * RTS threshold
5901 * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
5902 * if the selected rate supports it
5903 * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
5904 * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
5905 * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
5906 */
5907 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
5908 struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
5909 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
5910 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
5911 struct sk_buff *skb;
5912 struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
5913 bool rts, short_preamble;
5914 u32 rate_idx_mask;
5915 u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
5916 bool bss;
5917 };
5918
5919 /**
5920 * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
5921 */
5922 enum rate_control_capabilities {
5923 /**
5924 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
5925 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
5926 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
5927 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
5928 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
5929 */
5930 RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
5931 };
5932
5933 struct rate_control_ops {
5934 unsigned long capa;
5935 const char *name;
5936 void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct dentry *debugfsdir);
5937 void (*free)(void *priv);
5938
5939 void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
5940 void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5941 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
5942 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
5943 void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5944 struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
5945 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
5946 u32 changed);
5947 void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5948 void *priv_sta);
5949
5950 void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
5951 struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5952 void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
5953 void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5954 struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
5955 struct sk_buff *skb);
5956 void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
5957 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
5958
5959 void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
5960 struct dentry *dir);
5961
5962 u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
5963 };
5964
rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta * sta,enum nl80211_band band,int index)5965 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5966 enum nl80211_band band,
5967 int index)
5968 {
5969 return (sta == NULL || sta->supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
5970 }
5971
5972 static inline s8
rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)5973 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5974 struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
5975 {
5976 int i;
5977
5978 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
5979 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
5980 return i;
5981
5982 /* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
5983 WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
5984
5985 /* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
5986 return 0;
5987 }
5988
5989 static inline
rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band * sband,struct ieee80211_sta * sta)5990 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
5991 struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
5992 {
5993 unsigned int i;
5994
5995 for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
5996 if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
5997 return true;
5998 return false;
5999 }
6000
6001 /**
6002 * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
6003 *
6004 * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
6005 * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
6006 * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
6007 * the most recent rate control module decision.
6008 *
6009 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6010 * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
6011 * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
6012 */
6013 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6014 struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
6015 struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
6016
6017 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6018 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6019
6020 static inline bool
conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6021 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6022 {
6023 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
6024 }
6025
6026 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6027 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6028 {
6029 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6030 conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6031 }
6032
6033 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6034 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6035 {
6036 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6037 conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6038 }
6039
6040 static inline bool
conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6041 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6042 {
6043 return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
6044 }
6045
6046 static inline bool
conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf * conf)6047 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6048 {
6049 return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
6050 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
6051 (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
6052 }
6053
6054 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type,bool p2p)6055 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
6056 {
6057 if (p2p) {
6058 switch (type) {
6059 case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
6060 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
6061 case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
6062 return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
6063 default:
6064 break;
6065 }
6066 }
6067 return type;
6068 }
6069
6070 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif * vif)6071 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6072 {
6073 return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
6074 }
6075
6076 /**
6077 * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
6078 *
6079 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6080 * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
6081 * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
6082 *
6083 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
6084 * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
6085 * matching GroupId management frame.
6086 * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
6087 */
6088 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6089 const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
6090
6091 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6092 int rssi_min_thold,
6093 int rssi_max_thold);
6094
6095 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6096
6097 /**
6098 * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
6099 *
6100 * @vif: the specified virtual interface
6101 *
6102 * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
6103 *
6104 * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
6105 * applicable.
6106 */
6107 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6108
6109 /**
6110 * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
6111 * @vif: virtual interface
6112 * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
6113 * @gfp: allocation flags
6114 *
6115 * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
6116 */
6117 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6118 struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
6119 gfp_t gfp);
6120
6121 /**
6122 * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
6123 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6124 * @vif: virtual interface
6125 * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
6126 * @band: the band to transmit on
6127 * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
6128 *
6129 * Note: must be called under RCU lock
6130 */
6131 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6132 struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
6133 int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
6134
6135 /**
6136 * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
6137 *
6138 * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
6139 * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
6140 *
6141 * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
6142 *
6143 * private:
6144 *
6145 * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
6146 * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
6147 */
6148 struct ieee80211_noa_data {
6149 u32 next_tsf;
6150 bool has_next_tsf;
6151
6152 u8 absent;
6153
6154 u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
6155 struct {
6156 u32 start;
6157 u32 duration;
6158 u32 interval;
6159 } desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
6160 };
6161
6162 /**
6163 * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
6164 *
6165 * @attr: P2P NoA IE
6166 * @data: NoA tracking data
6167 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
6168 *
6169 * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
6170 */
6171 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
6172 struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
6173
6174 /**
6175 * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
6176 *
6177 * @data: NoA tracking data
6178 * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
6179 */
6180 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
6181
6182 /**
6183 * ieee80211_tdls_oper - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
6184 * @vif: virtual interface
6185 * @peer: the peer's destination address
6186 * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
6187 * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
6188 * @gfp: allocation flags
6189 *
6190 * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
6191 */
6192 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
6193 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
6194 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
6195
6196 /**
6197 * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
6198 *
6199 * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
6200 * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
6201 * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
6202 * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
6203 * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
6204 * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
6205 *
6206 * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
6207 * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
6208 * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
6209 *
6210 * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
6211 * @tid: the TID to reserve
6212 *
6213 * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
6214 */
6215 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
6216
6217 /**
6218 * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
6219 *
6220 * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
6221 * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
6222 * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
6223 *
6224 * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
6225 * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
6226 * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
6227 *
6228 * @sta: the station
6229 * @tid: the TID to unreserve
6230 */
6231 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
6232
6233 /**
6234 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
6235 *
6236 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6237 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
6238 * ieee80211_next_txq()
6239 *
6240 * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
6241 *
6242 * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
6243 * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
6244 * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by by RCU and thus the
6245 * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
6246 * but for the duration of the frame handling.
6247 * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
6248 * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
6249 *
6250 * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
6251 * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
6252 */
6253 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6254 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6255
6256 /**
6257 * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
6258 * (in process context)
6259 *
6260 * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
6261 * (internally disables bottom halves).
6262 *
6263 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6264 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
6265 * ieee80211_next_txq()
6266 */
ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)6267 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6268 struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
6269 {
6270 struct sk_buff *skb;
6271
6272 local_bh_disable();
6273 skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
6274 local_bh_enable();
6275
6276 return skb;
6277 }
6278
6279 /**
6280 * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
6281 *
6282 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6283 * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
6284 *
6285 * Returns the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
6286 * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
6287 * driver has finished scheduling it.
6288 */
6289 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
6290
6291 /**
6292 * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
6293 *
6294 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6295 * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
6296 *
6297 * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
6298 * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
6299 */
6300 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
6301
6302 /* (deprecated) */
ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,u8 ac)6303 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
6304 {
6305 }
6306
6307 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6308 struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
6309
6310 /**
6311 * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
6312 *
6313 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6314 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6315 *
6316 * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
6317 * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
6318 *
6319 * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
6320 * this TXQ internally.
6321 */
6322 static inline void
ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq)6323 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
6324 {
6325 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
6326 }
6327
6328 /**
6329 * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
6330 *
6331 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6332 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6333 * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
6334 *
6335 * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
6336 * internally.
6337 */
6338 static inline void
ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw * hw,struct ieee80211_txq * txq,bool force)6339 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
6340 bool force)
6341 {
6342 __ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
6343 }
6344
6345 /**
6346 * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
6347 *
6348 * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
6349 * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
6350 * fairness accounting without going using the scheduling order enfored by
6351 * next_txq().
6352 *
6353 * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
6354 * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
6355 * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
6356 * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
6357 * again.
6358 *
6359 * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
6360 * aligned aginst driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
6361 * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
6362 * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
6363 * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
6364 * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
6365 *
6366 * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6367 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6368 */
6369 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6370 struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6371
6372 /**
6373 * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
6374 *
6375 * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
6376 * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
6377 * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
6378 *
6379 * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6380 * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
6381 * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
6382 */
6383 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
6384 unsigned long *frame_cnt,
6385 unsigned long *byte_cnt);
6386
6387 /**
6388 * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
6389 *
6390 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
6391 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
6392 *
6393 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6394 * @inst_id: the local instance id
6395 * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
6396 * @gfp: allocation flags
6397 */
6398 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6399 u8 inst_id,
6400 enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
6401 gfp_t gfp);
6402
6403 /**
6404 * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
6405 *
6406 * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
6407 * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
6408 * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
6409 *
6410 * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6411 * @match: match event information
6412 * @gfp: allocation flags
6413 */
6414 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6415 struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
6416 gfp_t gfp);
6417
6418 #endif /* MAC80211_H */
6419